annotate runtime/doc/options.txt @ 819:23f82b5d2814 v7.0c10

updated for version 7.0c10
author vimboss
date Wed, 05 Apr 2006 20:41:53 +0000
parents 1f929f3ca806
children 8dd456c1e283
Ignore whitespace changes - Everywhere: Within whitespace: At end of lines:
rev   line source
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
1 *options.txt* For Vim version 7.0c. Last change: 2006 Apr 05
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7 Options *options*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
9 1. Setting options |set-option|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
10 2. Automatically setting options |auto-setting|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
11 3. Options summary |option-summary|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
12
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
13 For an overview of options see help.txt |option-list|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
14
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
15 Vim has a number of internal variables and switches which can be set to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
16 achieve special effects. These options come in three forms:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
17 boolean can only be on or off *boolean* *toggle*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
18 number has a numeric value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
19 string has a string value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
20
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
21 ==============================================================================
523
a7ae7e043e43 updated for version 7.0146
vimboss
parents: 519
diff changeset
22 1. Setting options *set-option* *E764*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
23
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
24 *:se* *:set*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
25 :se[t] Show all options that differ from their default value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
26
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
27 :se[t] all Show all but terminal options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
28
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
29 :se[t] termcap Show all terminal options. Note that in the GUI the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
30 key codes are not shown, because they are generated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
31 internally and can't be changed. Changing the terminal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
32 codes in the GUI is not useful either...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
33
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
34 *E518* *E519*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
35 :se[t] {option}? Show value of {option}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
36
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
37 :se[t] {option} Toggle option: set, switch it on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
38 Number option: show value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
39 String option: show value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
40
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
41 :se[t] no{option} Toggle option: Reset, switch it off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
42
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
43 :se[t] {option}! or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
44 :se[t] inv{option} Toggle option: Invert value. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
45
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
46 *:set-default* *:set-&* *:set-&vi* *:set-&vim*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
47 :se[t] {option}& Reset option to its default value. May depend on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
48 current value of 'compatible'. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
49 :se[t] {option}&vi Reset option to its Vi default value. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
50 :se[t] {option}&vim Reset option to its Vim default value. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
51
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
52 :se[t] all& Set all options, except terminal options, to their
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
53 default value. The values of 'term', 'lines' and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
54 'columns' are not changed. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
55
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
56 *:set-args* *E487* *E521*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
57 :se[t] {option}={value} or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
58 :se[t] {option}:{value}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
59 Set string or number option to {value}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
60 For numeric options the value can be given in decimal,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
61 hex (preceded with 0x) or octal (preceded with '0')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
62 (hex and octal are only available for machines which
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
63 have the strtol() function).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
64 The old value can be inserted by typing 'wildchar' (by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
65 default this is a <Tab> or CTRL-E if 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
66 set). See |cmdline-completion|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
67 White space between {option} and '=' is allowed and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
68 will be ignored. White space between '=' and {value}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
69 is not allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
70 See |option-backslash| for using white space and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
71 backslashes in {value}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
72
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
73 :se[t] {option}+={value} *:set+=*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
74 Add the {value} to a number option, or append the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
75 {value} to a string option. When the option is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
76 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
77 value was empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
78 If the option is a list of flags, superfluous flags
557
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
79 are removed. When adding a flag that was already
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
80 present the option value doesn't change.
809
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
81 Also see |:set-args| above.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
82 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
83
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
84 :se[t] {option}^={value} *:set^=*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
85 Multiply the {value} to a number option, or prepend
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
86 the {value} to a string option. When the option is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
87 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
88 value was empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
89 Also see |:set-args| above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
90 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
91
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
92 :se[t] {option}-={value} *:set-=*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
93 Subtract the {value} from a number option, or remove
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
94 the {value} from a string option, if it is there.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
95 If the {value} is not found in a string option, there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
96 is no error or warning. When the option is a comma
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
97 separated list, a comma is deleted, unless the option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
98 becomes empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
99 When the option is a list of flags, {value} must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
100 exactly as they appear in the option. Remove flags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
101 one by one to avoid problems.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
102 Also see |:set-args| above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
103 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
104
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
105 The {option} arguments to ":set" may be repeated. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
106 :set ai nosi sw=3 ts=3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
107 If you make an error in one of the arguments, an error message will be given
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
108 and the following arguments will be ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
109
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
110 *:set-verbose*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
111 When 'verbose' is non-zero, displaying an option value will also tell where it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
112 was last set. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
113 :verbose set shiftwidth cindent?
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
114 shiftwidth=4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
115 Last set from modeline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
116 cindent
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
117 Last set from /usr/local/share/vim/vim60/ftplugin/c.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
118 This is only done when specific option values are requested, not for ":set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
119 all" or ":set" without an argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
120 When the option was set by hand there is no "Last set" message. There is only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
121 one value for all local options with the same name. Thus the message applies
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
122 to the option name, not necessarily its value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
123 When the option was set while executing a function, user command or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
124 autocommand, the script in which it was defined is reported.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
125 Note that an option may also have been set as a side effect of setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
126 'compatible'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
127 {not available when compiled without the +eval feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
128
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
129 *:set-termcap* *E522*
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
130 For {option} the form "t_xx" may be used to set a terminal option. This will
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
131 override the value from the termcap. You can then use it in a mapping. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
132 the "xx" part contains special characters, use the <t_xx> form: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
133 :set <t_#4>=^[Ot
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
134 This can also be used to translate a special code for a normal key. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
135 example, if Alt-b produces <Esc>b, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
136 :set <M-b>=^[b
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
137 (the ^[ is a real <Esc> here, use CTRL-V <Esc> to enter it)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
138 The advantage over a mapping is that it works in all situations.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
139
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
140 The t_xx options cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
141 security reasons.
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
142
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
143 The listing from ":set" looks different from Vi. Long string options are put
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
144 at the end of the list. The number of options is quite large. The output of
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
145 "set all" probably does not fit on the screen, causing Vim to give the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
146 |more-prompt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
147
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
148 *option-backslash*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
149 To include white space in a string option value it has to be preceded with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
150 backslash. To include a backslash you have to use two. Effectively this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
151 means that the number of backslashes in an option value is halved (rounded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
152 down).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
153 A few examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
154 :set tags=tags\ /usr/tags results in "tags /usr/tags"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
155 :set tags=tags\\,file results in "tags\,file"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
156 :set tags=tags\\\ file results in "tags\ file"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
157
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
158 The "|" character separates a ":set" command from a following command. To
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
159 include the "|" in the option value, use "\|" instead. This example sets the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
160 'titlestring' option to "hi|there": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
161 :set titlestring=hi\|there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
162 This sets the 'titlestring' option to "hi" and 'iconstring' to "there": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
163 :set titlestring=hi|set iconstring=there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
164
642
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 634
diff changeset
165 Similarly, the double quote character starts a comment. To include the '"' in
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 634
diff changeset
166 the option value, use '\"' instead. This example sets the 'titlestring'
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 634
diff changeset
167 option to 'hi "there"': >
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 634
diff changeset
168 :set titlestring=hi\ \"there\"
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 634
diff changeset
169
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
170 For MS-DOS and WIN32 backslashes in file names are mostly not removed. More
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
171 precise: For options that expect a file name (those where environment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
172 variables are expanded) a backslash before a normal file name character is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
173 removed. But a backslash before a special character (space, backslash, comma,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
174 etc.) is used like explained above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
175 There is one special situation, when the value starts with "\\": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
176 :set dir=\\machine\path results in "\\machine\path"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
177 :set dir=\\\\machine\\path results in "\\machine\path"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
178 :set dir=\\path\\file results in "\\path\file" (wrong!)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
179 For the first one the start is kept, but for the second one the backslashes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
180 are halved. This makes sure it works both when you expect backslashes to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
181 halved and when you expect the backslashes to be kept. The third gives a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
182 result which is probably not what you want. Avoid it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
183
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
184 *add-option-flags* *remove-option-flags*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
185 *E539* *E550* *E551* *E552*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
186 Some options are a list of flags. When you want to add a flag to such an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
187 option, without changing the existing ones, you can do it like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
188 :set guioptions+=a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
189 Remove a flag from an option like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
190 :set guioptions-=a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
191 This removes the 'a' flag from 'guioptions'.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
192 Note that you should add or remove one flag at a time. If 'guioptions' has
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
193 the value "ab", using "set guioptions-=ba" won't work, because the string "ba"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
194 doesn't appear.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
195
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
196 *:set_env* *expand-env* *expand-environment-var*
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 20
diff changeset
197 Environment variables in specific string options will be expanded. If the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
198 environment variable exists the '$' and the following environment variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
199 name is replaced with its value. If it does not exist the '$' and the name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
200 are not modified. Any non-id character (not a letter, digit or '_') may
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
201 follow the environment variable name. That character and what follows is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
202 appended to the value of the environment variable. Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
203 :set term=$TERM.new
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
204 :set path=/usr/$INCLUDE,$HOME/include,.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
205 When adding or removing a string from an option with ":set opt-=val" or ":set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
206 opt+=val" the expansion is done before the adding or removing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
207
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
208
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
209 Handling of local options *local-options*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
210
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
211 Some of the options only apply to a window or buffer. Each window or buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
212 has its own copy of this option, thus can each have their own value. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
213 allows you to set 'list' in one window but not in another. And set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
214 'shiftwidth' to 3 in one buffer and 4 in another.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
215
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
216 The following explains what happens to these local options in specific
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
217 situations. You don't really need to know all of this, since Vim mostly uses
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
218 the option values you would expect. Unfortunately, doing what the user
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
219 expects is a bit complicated...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
220
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
221 When splitting a window, the local options are copied to the new window. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
222 right after the split the contents of the two windows look the same.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
223
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
224 When editing a new buffer, its local option values must be initialized. Since
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
225 the local options of the current buffer might be specifically for that buffer,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
226 these are not used. Instead, for each buffer-local option there also is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
227 global value, which is used for new buffers. With ":set" both the local and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
228 global value is changed. With "setlocal" only the local value is changed,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
229 thus this value is not used when editing a new buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
230
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
231 When editing a buffer that has been edited before, the last used window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
232 options are used again. If this buffer has been edited in this window, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
233 values from back then are used. Otherwise the values from the window where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
234 the buffer was edited last are used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
235
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
236 It's possible to set a local window option specifically for a type of buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
237 When you edit another buffer in the same window, you don't want to keep
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
238 using these local window options. Therefore Vim keeps a global value of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
239 local window options, which is used when editing another buffer. Each window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
240 has its own copy of these values. Thus these are local to the window, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
241 global to all buffers in the window. With this you can do: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
242 :e one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
243 :set list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
244 :e two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
245 Now the 'list' option will also be set in "two", since with the ":set list"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
246 command you have also set the global value. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
247 :set nolist
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
248 :e one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
249 :setlocal list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
250 :e two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
251 Now the 'list' option is not set, because ":set nolist" resets the global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
252 value, ":setlocal list" only changes the local value and ":e two" gets the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
253 global value. Note that if you do this next: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
254 :e one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
255 You will not get back the 'list' value as it was the last time you edited
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
256 "one". The options local to a window are not remembered for each buffer.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
257
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
258 *:setl* *:setlocal*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
259 :setl[ocal] ... Like ":set" but set only the value local to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
260 current buffer or window. Not all options have a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
261 local value. If the option does not have a local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
262 value the global value is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
263 With the "all" argument: display all local option's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
264 local values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
265 Without argument: Display all local option's local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
266 values which are different from the default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
267 When displaying a specific local option, show the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
268 local value. For a global option the global value is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
269 shown (but that might change in the future).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
270 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
271
809
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
272 :setl[ocal] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value by
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
273 copying the value.
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
274 {not in Vi}
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
275
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
276 :se[t] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value by
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
277 making it empty. Only makes sense for |global-local|
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
278 options.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
279 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
280
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
281 *:setg* *:setglobal*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
282 :setg[lobal] ... Like ":set" but set only the global value for a local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
283 option without changing the local value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
284 When displaying an option, the global value is shown.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
285 With the "all" argument: display all local option's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
286 global values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
287 Without argument: display all local option's global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
288 values which are different from the default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
289 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
290
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
291 For buffer-local and window-local options:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
292 Command global value local value ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
293 :set option=value set set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
294 :setlocal option=value - set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
295 :setglobal option=value set -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
296 :set option? - display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
297 :setlocal option? - display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
298 :setglobal option? display -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
299
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
300
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
301 Global options with a local value *global-local*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
302
40
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
303 Options are global when you mostly use one value for all buffers and windows.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
304 For some global options it's useful to sometimes have a different local value.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
305 You can set the local value with ":setlocal". That buffer or window will then
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
306 use the local value, while other buffers and windows continue using the global
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
307 value.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
308
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
309 For example, you have two windows, both on C source code. They use the global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
310 'makeprg' option. If you do this in one of the two windows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
311 :set makeprg=gmake
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
312 then the other window will switch to the same value. There is no need to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
313 the 'makeprg' option in the other C source window too.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
314 However, if you start editing a Perl file in a new window, you want to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
315 another 'makeprog' for it, without changing the value used for the C source
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
316 files. You use this command: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
317 :setlocal makeprg=perlmake
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
318 You can switch back to using the global value by making the local value empty: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
319 :setlocal makeprg=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
320 This only works for a string option. For a boolean option you need to use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
321 "<" flag, like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
322 :setlocal autoread<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
323 Note that for non-boolean options using "<" copies the global value to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
324 local value, it doesn't switch back to using the global value (that matters
809
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
325 when the global value changes later). You can also use: >
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
326 :set path<
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
327 This will make the local value of 'path' empty, so that the global value is
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
328 used. Thus it does the same as: >
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
329 :setlocal path=
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
330 Note: In the future more global options can be made global-local. Using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
331 ":setlocal" on a global option might work differently then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
332
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
333
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
334 Setting the filetype
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
335
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
336 :setf[iletype] {filetype} *:setf* *:setfiletype*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
337 Set the 'filetype' option to {filetype}, but only if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
338 not done yet in a sequence of (nested) autocommands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
339 This is short for: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
340 :if !did_filetype()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
341 : setlocal filetype={filetype}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
342 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
343 < This command is used in a filetype.vim file to avoid
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
344 setting the 'filetype' option twice, causing different
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
345 settings and syntax files to be loaded.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
346 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
347
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
348 :bro[wse] se[t] *:set-browse* *:browse-set* *:opt* *:options*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
349 :opt[ions] Open a window for viewing and setting all options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
350 Options are grouped by function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
351 Offers short help for each option. Hit <CR> on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
352 short help to open a help window with more help for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
353 the option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
354 Modify the value of the option and hit <CR> on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
355 "set" line to set the new value. For window and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
356 buffer specific options, the last accessed window is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
357 used to set the option value in, unless this is a help
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
358 window, in which case the window below help window is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
359 used (skipping the option-window).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
360 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
361 |+autocmd| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
362
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
363 *$HOME*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
364 Using "~" is like using "$HOME", but it is only recognized at the start of an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
365 option and after a space or comma.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
366
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
367 On Unix systems "~user" can be used too. It is replaced by the home directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
368 of user "user". Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
369 :set path=~mool/include,/usr/include,.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
370
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
371 On Unix systems the form "${HOME}" can be used too. The name between {} can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
372 contain non-id characters then. Note that if you want to use this for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
373 "gf" command, you need to add the '{' and '}' characters to 'isfname'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
374
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
375 NOTE: expanding environment variables and "~/" is only done with the ":set"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
376 command, not when assigning a value to an option with ":let".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
377
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
378
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
379 Note the maximum length of an expanded option is limited. How much depends on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
380 the system, mostly it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
381
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
382 *:fix* *:fixdel*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
383 :fix[del] Set the value of 't_kD':
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
384 't_kb' is 't_kD' becomes ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
385 CTRL-? CTRL-H
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
386 not CTRL-? CTRL-?
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
387
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
388 (CTRL-? is 0177 octal, 0x7f hex) {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
389
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
390 If your delete key terminal code is wrong, but the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
391 code for backspace is alright, you can put this in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
392 your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
393 :fixdel
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
394 < This works no matter what the actual code for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
395 backspace is.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
396
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
397 If the backspace key terminal code is wrong you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
398 use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
399 :if &term == "termname"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
400 : set t_kb=^V<BS>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
401 : fixdel
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
402 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
403 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<BS>" is the backspace key
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
404 (don't type four characters!). Replace "termname"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
405 with your terminal name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
406
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
407 If your <Delete> key sends a strange key sequence (not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
408 CTRL-? or CTRL-H) you cannot use ":fixdel". Then use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
409 :if &term == "termname"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
410 : set t_kD=^V<Delete>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
411 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
412 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<Delete>" is the delete key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
413 (don't type eight characters!). Replace "termname"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
414 with your terminal name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
415
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
416 *Linux-backspace*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
417 Note about Linux: By default the backspace key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
418 produces CTRL-?, which is wrong. You can fix it by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
419 putting this line in your rc.local: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
420 echo "keycode 14 = BackSpace" | loadkeys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
421 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
422 *NetBSD-backspace*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
423 Note about NetBSD: If your backspace doesn't produce
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
424 the right code, try this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
425 xmodmap -e "keycode 22 = BackSpace"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
426 < If this works, add this in your .Xmodmap file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
427 keysym 22 = BackSpace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
428 < You need to restart for this to take effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
429
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
430 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
431 2. Automatically setting options *auto-setting*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
432
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
433 Besides changing options with the ":set" command, there are three alternatives
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
434 to set options automatically for one or more files:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
435
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
436 1. When starting Vim initializations are read from various places. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
437 |initialization|. Most of them are performed for all editing sessions,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
438 and some of them depend on the directory where Vim is started.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
439 You can create an initialization file with |:mkvimrc|, |:mkview| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
440 |:mksession|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
441 2. If you start editing a new file, the automatic commands are executed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
442 This can be used to set options for files matching a particular pattern and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
443 many other things. See |autocommand|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
444 3. If you start editing a new file, and the 'modeline' option is on, a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
445 number of lines at the beginning and end of the file are checked for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
446 modelines. This is explained here.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
447
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
448 *modeline* *vim:* *vi:* *ex:* *E520*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
449 There are two forms of modelines. The first form:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
450 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]{options}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
451
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
452 [text] any text or empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
453 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
454 {vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
455 [white] optional white space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
456 {options} a list of option settings, separated with white space or ':',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
457 where each part between ':' is the argument for a ":set"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
458 command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
459
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
460 Example:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
461 vi:noai:sw=3 ts=6 ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
462
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
463 The second form (this is compatible with some versions of Vi):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
464
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
465 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]se[t] {options}:[text]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
466
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
467 [text] any text or empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
468 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
469 {vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
470 [white] optional white space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
471 se[t] the string "set " or "se " (note the space)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
472 {options} a list of options, separated with white space, which is the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
473 argument for a ":set" command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
474 : a colon
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
475 [text] any text or empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
476
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
477 Example:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
478 /* vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
479
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
480 The white space before {vi:|vim:|ex:} is required. This minimizes the chance
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
481 that a normal word like "lex:" is caught. There is one exception: "vi:" and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
482 "vim:" can also be at the start of the line (for compatibility with version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
483 3.0). Using "ex:" at the start of the line will be ignored (this could be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
484 short for "example:").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
485
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
486 *modeline-local*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
487 The options are set like with ":setlocal": The new value only applies to the
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
488 buffer and window that contain the file. Although it's possible to set global
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
489 options from a modeline, this is unusual. If you have two windows open and
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
490 the files in it set the same global option to a different value, the result
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
491 depends on which one was opened last.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
492
23
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
493 When editing a file that was already loaded, only the window-local options
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
494 from the modeline are used. Thus if you manually changed a buffer-local
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
495 option after opening the file, it won't be changed if you edit the same buffer
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
496 in another window. But window-local options will be set.
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
497
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
498 *modeline-version*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
499 If the modeline is only to be used for some versions of Vim, the version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
500 number can be specified where "vim:" is used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
501 vim{vers}: version {vers} or later
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
502 vim<{vers}: version before {vers}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
503 vim={vers}: version {vers}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
504 vim>{vers}: version after {vers}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
505 {vers} is 600 for Vim 6.0 (hundred times the major version plus minor).
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
506 For example, to use a modeline only for Vim 6.0 and later:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
507 /* vim600: set foldmethod=marker: */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
508 To use a modeline for Vim before version 5.7:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
509 /* vim<570: set sw=4: */ ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
510 There can be no blanks between "vim" and the ":".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
511
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
512
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
513 The number of lines that are checked can be set with the 'modelines' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
514 If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is 0 no lines are checked.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
515
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
516 Note that for the first form all of the rest of the line is used, thus a line
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
517 like:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
518 /* vi:ts=4: */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
519 will give an error message for the trailing "*/". This line is OK:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
520 /* vi:set ts=4: */ ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
521
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
522 If an error is detected the rest of the line is skipped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
523
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
524 If you want to include a ':' in a set command precede it with a '\'. The
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
525 backslash in front of the ':' will be removed. Example:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
526 /* vi:set dir=c\:\tmp: */ ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
527 This sets the 'dir' option to "c:\tmp". Only a single backslash before the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
528 ':' is removed. Thus to include "\:" you have to specify "\\:".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
529
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
530 No other commands than "set" are supported, for security reasons (somebody
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
531 might create a Trojan horse text file with modelines).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
532
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
533 Hint: If you would like to do something else than setting an option, you could
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
534 define an autocommand that checks the file for a specific string. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
535 example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
536 au BufReadPost * if getline(1) =~ "VAR" | call SetVar() | endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
537 And define a function SetVar() that does something with the line containing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
538 "VAR".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
539
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
540 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
541 3. Options summary *option-summary*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
542
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
543 In the list below all the options are mentioned with their full name and with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
544 an abbreviation if there is one. Both forms may be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
545
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
546 In this document when a boolean option is "set" that means that ":set option"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
547 is entered. When an option is "reset", ":set nooption" is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
548
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
549 For some options there are two default values: The "Vim default", which is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
550 used when 'compatible' is not set, and the "Vi default", which is used when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
551 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
552
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
553 Most options are the same in all windows and buffers. There are a few that
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
554 are specific to how the text is presented in a window. These can be set to a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
555 different value in each window. For example the 'list' option can be set in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
556 one window and reset in another for the same text, giving both types of view
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
557 at the same time. There are a few options that are specific to a certain
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
558 file. These can have a different value for each file or buffer. For example
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
559 the 'textwidth' option can be 78 for a normal text file and 0 for a C
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
560 program.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
561
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
562 global one option for all buffers and windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
563 local to window each window has its own copy of this option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
564 local to buffer each buffer has its own copy of this option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
565
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
566 When creating a new window the option values from the currently active window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
567 are used as a default value for the window-specific options. For the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
568 buffer-specific options this depends on the 's' and 'S' flags in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
569 'cpoptions' option. If 's' is included (which is the default) the values for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
570 buffer options are copied from the currently active buffer when a buffer is
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
571 first entered. If 'S' is present the options are copied each time the buffer
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
572 is entered, this is almost like having global options. If 's' and 'S' are not
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
573 present, the options are copied from the currently active buffer when the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
574 buffer is created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
575
519
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
576 Hidden options *hidden-options*
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
577
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
578 Not all options are supported in all versions. This depends on the supported
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
579 features and sometimes on the system. A remark about this is in curly braces
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
580 below. When an option is not supported it may still be set without getting an
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
581 error, this is called a hidden option. You can't get the value of a hidden
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
582 option though, it is not stored.
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
583
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
584 To test if option "foo" can be used with ":set" use something like this: >
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
585 if exists('&foo')
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
586 This also returns true for a hidden option. To test if option "foo" is really
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
587 supported use something like this: >
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
588 if exists('+foo')
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
589 <
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
590 *E355*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
591 A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
592
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
593 *'aleph'* *'al'* *aleph* *Aleph*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
594 'aleph' 'al' number (default 128 for MS-DOS, 224 otherwise)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
595 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
596 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
597 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
598 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
599 The ASCII code for the first letter of the Hebrew alphabet. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
600 routine that maps the keyboard in Hebrew mode, both in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
601 (when hkmap is set) and on the command-line (when hitting CTRL-_)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
602 outputs the Hebrew characters in the range [aleph..aleph+26].
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
603 aleph=128 applies to PC code, and aleph=224 applies to ISO 8859-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
604 See |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
605
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
606 *'allowrevins'* *'ari'* *'noallowrevins'* *'noari'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
607 'allowrevins' 'ari' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
608 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
609 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
610 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
611 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
612 Allow CTRL-_ in Insert and Command-line mode. This is default off, to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
613 avoid that users that accidentally type CTRL-_ instead of SHIFT-_ get
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
614 into reverse Insert mode, and don't know how to get out. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
615 'revins'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
616 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
617
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
618 *'altkeymap'* *'akm'* *'noaltkeymap'* *'noakm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
619 'altkeymap' 'akm' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
620 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
621 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
622 {only available when compiled with the |+farsi|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
623 feature}
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
624 When on, the second language is Farsi. In editing mode CTRL-_ toggles
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
625 the keyboard map between Farsi and English, when 'allowrevins' set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
626
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
627 When off, the keyboard map toggles between Hebrew and English. This
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
628 is useful to start the Vim in native mode i.e. English (left-to-right
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
629 mode) and have default second language Farsi or Hebrew (right-to-left
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
630 mode). See |farsi.txt|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
631
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
632 *'ambiwidth'* *'ambw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
633 'ambiwidth' 'ambw' string (default: "single")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
634 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
635 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
636 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
637 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
638 Only effective when 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
639 Tells Vim what to do with characters with East Asian Width Class
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
640 Ambiguous (such as Euro, Registered Sign, Copyright Sign, Greek
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
641 letters, Cyrillic letters).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
642
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
643 There are currently two possible values:
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
644 "single": Use the same width as characters in US-ASCII. This is
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
645 expected by most users.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
646 "double": Use twice the width of ASCII characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
647
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
648 There are a number of CJK fonts for which the width of glyphs for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
649 those characters are solely based on how many octets they take in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
650 legacy/traditional CJK encodings. In those encodings, Euro,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
651 Registered sign, Greek/Cyrillic letters are represented by two octets,
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
652 therefore those fonts have "wide" glyphs for them. This is also
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
653 true of some line drawing characters used to make tables in text
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
654 file. Therefore, when a CJK font is used for GUI Vim or
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
655 Vim is running inside a terminal (emulators) that uses a CJK font
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
656 (or Vim is run inside an xterm invoked with "-cjkwidth" option.),
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
657 this option should be set to "double" to match the width perceived
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
658 by Vim with the width of glyphs in the font. Perhaps it also has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
659 to be set to "double" under CJK Windows 9x/ME or Windows 2k/XP
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
660 when the system locale is set to one of CJK locales. See Unicode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
661 Standard Annex #11 (http://www.unicode.org/reports/tr11).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
662
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
663 *'antialias'* *'anti'* *'noantialias'* *'noanti'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
664 'antialias' 'anti' boolean (default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
665 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
666 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
667 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
668 on Mac OS X}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
669 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim on Mac OS X
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
670 v10.2 or later. When on, Vim will use smooth ("antialiased") fonts,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
671 which can be easier to read at certain sizes on certain displays.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
672 Setting this option can sometimes cause problems if 'guifont' is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
673 to its default (empty string).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
674
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
675 *'autochdir'* *'acd'* *'noautochdir'* *'noacd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
676 'autochdir' 'acd' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
677 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
678 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
679 {only available when compiled with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
680 |+netbeans_intg| or |+sun_workshop| feature}
438
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
681 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
682 open a file, switch buffers, delete a buffer or open/close a window.
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
683 It will change to the directory containing the file which was opened
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
684 or selected.
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
685 This option is provided for backward compatibility with the Vim
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
686 released with Sun ONE Studio 4 Enterprise Edition.
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
687 Note: When this option is on some plugins may not work.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
688
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
689 *'arabic'* *'arab'* *'noarabic'* *'noarab'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
690 'arabic' 'arab' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
691 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
692 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
693 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
694 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
695 This option can be set to start editing Arabic text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
696 Setting this option will:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
697 - Set the 'rightleft' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
698 - Set the 'arabicshape' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
699 - Set the 'keymap' option to "arabic"; in Insert mode CTRL-^ toggles
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
700 between typing English and Arabic key mapping.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
701 - Set the 'delcombine' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
702 Note that 'encoding' must be "utf-8" for working with Arabic text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
703
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
704 Resetting this option will:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
705 - Reset the 'rightleft' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
706 - Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
707 Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
708 option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
709 Also see |arabic.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
710
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
711 *'arabicshape'* *'arshape'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
712 *'noarabicshape'* *'noarshape'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
713 'arabicshape' 'arshape' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
714 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
715 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
716 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
717 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
718 When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
719 corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
720 take affect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
721 one which encompasses:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
722 a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
723 within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
724 b) the enabling of the ability to compose characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
725 c) the enabling of the required combining of some characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
726 When disabled the character display reverts back to each character's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
727 true stand-alone form.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
728 Arabic is a complex language which requires other settings, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
729 further details see |arabic.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
730
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
731 *'autoindent'* *'ai'* *'noautoindent'* *'noai'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
732 'autoindent' 'ai' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
733 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
734 Copy indent from current line when starting a new line (typing <CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
735 in Insert mode or when using the "o" or "O" command). If you do not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
736 type anything on the new line except <BS> or CTRL-D and then type
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
737 <Esc> or <CR>, the indent is deleted again. Moving the cursor to
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
738 another line has the same effect, unless the 'I' flag is included in
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
739 'cpoptions'.
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
740 When autoindent is on, formatting (with the "gq" command or when you
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
741 reach 'textwidth' in Insert mode) uses the indentation of the first
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
742 line.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
743 When 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is on the indent is changed in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
744 a different way.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
745 The 'autoindent' option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
746 {small difference from Vi: After the indent is deleted when typing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
747 <Esc> or <CR>, the cursor position when moving up or down is after the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
748 deleted indent; Vi puts the cursor somewhere in the deleted indent}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
749
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
750 *'autoread'* *'ar'* *'noautoread'* *'noar'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
751 'autoread' 'ar' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
752 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
753 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
754 When a file has been detected to have been changed outside of Vim and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
755 it has not been changed inside of Vim, automatically read it again.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
756 When the file has been deleted this is not done. |timestamp|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
757 If this option has a local value, use this command to switch back to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
758 using the global value: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
759 :set autoread<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
760 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
761 *'autowrite'* *'aw'* *'noautowrite'* *'noaw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
762 'autowrite' 'aw' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
763 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
764 Write the contents of the file, if it has been modified, on each
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
765 :next, :rewind, :last, :first, :previous, :stop, :suspend, :tag, :!,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
766 :make, CTRL-] and CTRL-^ command; and when a CTRL-O, CTRL-I,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
767 '{A-Z0-9}, or `{A-Z0-9} command takes one to another file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
768 Note that for some commands the 'autowrite' option is not used, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
769 'autowriteall' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
770
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
771 *'autowriteall'* *'awa'* *'noautowriteall'* *'noawa'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
772 'autowriteall' 'awa' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
773 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
774 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
775 Like 'autowrite', but also used for commands ":edit", ":enew", ":quit",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
776 ":qall", ":exit", ":xit", ":recover" and closing the Vim window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
777 Setting this option also implies that Vim behaves like 'autowrite' has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
778 been set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
779
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
780 *'background'* *'bg'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
781 'background' 'bg' string (default "dark" or "light")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
782 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
783 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
784 When set to "dark", Vim will try to use colors that look good on a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
785 dark background. When set to "light", Vim will try to use colors that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
786 look good on a light background. Any other value is illegal.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
787 Vim tries to set the default value according to the terminal used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
788 This will not always be correct.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
789 Setting this option does not change the background color, it tells Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
790 what the background color looks like. For changing the background
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
791 color, see |:hi-normal|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
792
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
793 When 'background' is set Vim will adjust the default color groups for
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
794 the new value. But the colors used for syntax highlighting will not
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
795 change.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
796 When a color scheme is loaded (the "colors_name" variable is set)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
797 setting 'background' will cause the color scheme to be reloaded. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
798 the color scheme adjusts to the value of 'background' this will work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
799 However, if the color scheme sets 'background' itself the effect may
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
800 be undone. First delete the "colors_name" variable when needed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
801
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
802 When setting 'background' to the default value with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
803 :set background&
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
804 < Vim will guess the value. In the GUI this should work correctly,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
805 in other cases Vim might not be able to guess the right value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
806
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
807 When starting the GUI, the default value for 'background' will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
808 "light". When the value is not set in the .gvimrc, and Vim detects
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
809 that the background is actually quite dark, 'background' is set to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
810 "dark". But this happens only AFTER the .gvimrc file has been read
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
811 (because the window needs to be opened to find the actual background
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
812 color). To get around this, force the GUI window to be opened by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
813 putting a ":gui" command in the .gvimrc file, before where the value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
814 of 'background' is used (e.g., before ":syntax on").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
815 Normally this option would be set in the .vimrc file. Possibly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
816 depending on the terminal name. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
817 :if &term == "pcterm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
818 : set background=dark
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
819 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
820 < When this option is set, the default settings for the highlight groups
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
821 will change. To use other settings, place ":highlight" commands AFTER
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
822 the setting of the 'background' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
823 This option is also used in the "$VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim" file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
824 to select the colors for syntax highlighting. After changing this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
825 option, you must load syntax.vim again to see the result. This can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
826 done with ":syntax on".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
827
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
828 *'backspace'* *'bs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
829 'backspace' 'bs' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
830 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
831 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
832 Influences the working of <BS>, <Del>, CTRL-W and CTRL-U in Insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
833 mode. This is a list of items, separated by commas. Each item allows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
834 a way to backspace over something:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
835 value effect ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
836 indent allow backspacing over autoindent
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
837 eol allow backspacing over line breaks (join lines)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
838 start allow backspacing over the start of insert; CTRL-W and CTRL-U
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
839 stop once at the start of insert.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
840
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
841 When the value is empty, Vi compatible backspacing is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
842
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
843 For backwards compatibility with version 5.4 and earlier:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
844 value effect ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
845 0 same as ":set backspace=" (Vi compatible)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
846 1 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
847 2 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,start"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
848
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
849 See |:fixdel| if your <BS> or <Del> key does not do what you want.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
850 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
851
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
852 *'backup'* *'bk'* *'nobackup'* *'nobk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
853 'backup' 'bk' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
854 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
855 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
856 Make a backup before overwriting a file. Leave it around after the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
857 file has been successfully written. If you do not want to keep the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
858 backup file, but you do want a backup while the file is being
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
859 written, reset this option and set the 'writebackup' option (this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
860 the default). If you do not want a backup file at all reset both
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
861 options (use this if your file system is almost full). See the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
862 |backup-table| for more explanations.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
863 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
864 When 'patchmode' is set, the backup may be renamed to become the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
865 oldest version of a file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
866 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
867
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
868 *'backupcopy'* *'bkc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
869 'backupcopy' 'bkc' string (Vi default for Unix: "yes", otherwise: "auto")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
870 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
871 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
872 When writing a file and a backup is made, this option tells how it's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
873 done. This is a comma separated list of words.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
874
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
875 The main values are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
876 "yes" make a copy of the file and overwrite the original one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
877 "no" rename the file and write a new one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
878 "auto" one of the previous, what works best
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
879
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
880 Extra values that can be combined with the ones above are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
881 "breaksymlink" always break symlinks when writing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
882 "breakhardlink" always break hardlinks when writing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
883
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
884 Making a copy and overwriting the original file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
885 - Takes extra time to copy the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
886 + When the file has special attributes, is a (hard/symbolic) link or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
887 has a resource fork, all this is preserved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
888 - When the file is a link the backup will have the name of the link,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
889 not of the real file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
890
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
891 Renaming the file and writing a new one:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
892 + It's fast.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
893 - Sometimes not all attributes of the file can be copied to the new
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
894 file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
895 - When the file is a link the new file will not be a link.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
896
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
897 The "auto" value is the middle way: When Vim sees that renaming file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
898 is possible without side effects (the attributes can be passed on and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
899 and the file is not a link) that is used. When problems are expected,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
900 a copy will be made.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
901
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
902 The "breaksymlink" and "breakhardlink" values can be used in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
903 combination with any of "yes", "no" and "auto". When included, they
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
904 force Vim to always break either symbolic or hard links by doing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
905 exactly what the "no" option does, renaming the original file to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
906 become the backup and writing a new file in its place. This can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
907 useful for example in source trees where all the files are symbolic or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
908 hard links and any changes should stay in the local source tree, not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
909 be propagated back to the original source.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
910 *crontab*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
911 One situation where "no" and "auto" will cause problems: A program
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
912 that opens a file, invokes Vim to edit that file, and then tests if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
913 the open file was changed (through the file descriptor) will check the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
914 backup file instead of the newly created file. "crontab -e" is an
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
915 example.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
916
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
917 When a copy is made, the original file is truncated and then filled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
918 with the new text. This means that protection bits, owner and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
919 symbolic links of the original file are unmodified. The backup file
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
920 however, is a new file, owned by the user who edited the file. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
921 group of the backup is set to the group of the original file. If this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
922 fails, the protection bits for the group are made the same as for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
923 others.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
924
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
925 When the file is renamed this is the other way around: The backup has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
926 the same attributes of the original file, and the newly written file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
927 is owned by the current user. When the file was a (hard/symbolic)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
928 link, the new file will not! That's why the "auto" value doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
929 rename when the file is a link. The owner and group of the newly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
930 written file will be set to the same ones as the original file, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
931 the system may refuse to do this. In that case the "auto" value will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
932 again not rename the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
933
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
934 *'backupdir'* *'bdir'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
935 'backupdir' 'bdir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
936 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,c:/tmp,c:/temp"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
937 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,~/")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
938 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
939 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
940 List of directories for the backup file, separated with commas.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
941 - The backup file will be created in the first directory in the list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
942 where this is possible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
943 - Empty means that no backup file will be created ('patchmode' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
944 impossible!). Writing may fail because of this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
945 - A directory "." means to put the backup file in the same directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
946 as the edited file.
33
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
947 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
948 put the backup file relative to where the edited file is. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
949 leading "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
950 ("." inside a directory name has no special meaning).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
951 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
952 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
953 name, precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
954 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
955 - A directory name may end in an '/'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
956 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
957 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
958 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
959 :set bdir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
960 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
961 of the option is removed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
962 See also 'backup' and 'writebackup' options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
963 If you want to hide your backup files on Unix, consider this value: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
964 :set backupdir=./.backup,~/.backup,.,/tmp
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
965 < You must create a ".backup" directory in each directory and in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
966 home directory for this to work properly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
967 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
968 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
969 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
970 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
971 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
972
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
973 *'backupext'* *'bex'* *E589*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
974 'backupext' 'bex' string (default "~", for VMS: "_")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
975 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
976 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
977 String which is appended to a file name to make the name of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
978 backup file. The default is quite unusual, because this avoids
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
979 accidentally overwriting existing files with a backup file. You might
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
980 prefer using ".bak", but make sure that you don't have files with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
981 ".bak" that you want to keep.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
982 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
983
26
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
984 If you like to keep a lot of backups, you could use a BufWritePre
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
985 autocommand to change 'backupext' just before writing the file to
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
986 include a timestamp. >
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
987 :au BufWritePre * let &bex = '-' . strftime("%Y%b%d%X") . '~'
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
988 < Use 'backupdir' to put the backup in a different directory.
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
989
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
990 *'backupskip'* *'bsk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
991 'backupskip' 'bsk' string (default: "/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
992 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
993 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
994 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
995 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
996 A list of file patterns. When one of the patterns matches with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
997 name of the file which is written, no backup file is created. Both
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
998 the specified file name and the full path name of the file are used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
999 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1000 Watch out for special characters, see |option-backslash|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1001 When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
1002 default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix.
557
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
1003 Note that the default also makes sure that "crontab -e" works (when a
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
1004 backup would be made by renaming the original file crontab won't see
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
1005 the newly created file). Also see 'backupcopy' and |crontab|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1006
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1007 *'balloondelay'* *'bdlay'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1008 'balloondelay' 'bdlay' number (default: 600)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1009 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1010 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1011 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1012 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1013 Delay in milliseconds before a balloon may pop up. See |balloon-eval|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1014
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1015 *'ballooneval'* *'beval'* *'noballooneval'* *'nobeval'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1016 'ballooneval' 'beval' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1017 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1018 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1019 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1020 feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1021 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1022
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1023 *'balloonexpr'* *'bexpr'*
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1024 'balloonexpr' 'bexpr' string (default "")
790
c8680debe1cc updated for version 7.0230
vimboss
parents: 782
diff changeset
1025 global or local to buffer |global-local|
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1026 {not in Vi}
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1027 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1028 feature}
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
1029 Expression for text to show in evaluation balloon. It is only used
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
1030 when 'ballooneval' is on. These variables can be used:
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1031
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1032 v:beval_bufnr number of the buffer in which balloon is going to show
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1033 v:beval_winnr number of the window
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1034 v:beval_lnum line number
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1035 v:beval_col column number (byte index)
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1036 v:beval_text word under or after the mouse pointer
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1037
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1038 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects!
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1039 Example: >
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1040 function! MyBalloonExpr()
435
73f016dbb279 updated for version 7.0112
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
1041 return 'Cursor is at line ' . v:beval_lnum .
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1042 \', column ' . v:beval_col .
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1043 \ ' of file ' . bufname(v:beval_bufnr) .
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1044 \ ' on word "' . v:beval_text . '"'
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1045 endfunction
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1046 set bexpr=MyBalloonExpr()
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1047 set ballooneval
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1048 <
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1049 NOTE: The balloon is displayed only if the cursor is on a text
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1050 character. If the result of evaluating 'balloonexpr' is not empty,
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1051 Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1052 or Sun Workshop).
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1053
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1054 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1055 |sandbox-option|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1056
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1057 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1058 evaluating 'balloonexpr' |textlock|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1059
446
7472c565592a updated for version 7.0117
vimboss
parents: 438
diff changeset
1060 To check whether line breaks in the balloon text work use this check: >
435
73f016dbb279 updated for version 7.0112
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
1061 if has("balloon_multiline")
714
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
1062 < When they are supported "\n" characters will start a new line. If the
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
1063 expression evaluates to a |List| this is equal to using each List item
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
1064 as a string and putting "\n" in between them.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
1065
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1066 *'binary'* *'bin'* *'nobinary'* *'nobin'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1067 'binary' 'bin' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1068 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1069 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1070 This option should be set before editing a binary file. You can also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1071 use the |-b| Vim argument. When this option is switched on a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1072 options will be changed (also when it already was on):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1073 'textwidth' will be set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1074 'wrapmargin' will be set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1075 'modeline' will be off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1076 'expandtab' will be off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1077 Also, 'fileformat' and 'fileformats' options will not be used, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1078 file is read and written like 'fileformat' was "unix" (a single <NL>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1079 separates lines).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1080 The 'fileencoding' and 'fileencodings' options will not be used, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1081 file is read without conversion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1082 NOTE: When you start editing a(nother) file while the 'bin' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1083 on, settings from autocommands may change the settings again (e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1084 'textwidth'), causing trouble when editing. You might want to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1085 'bin' again when the file has been loaded.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1086 The previous values of these options are remembered and restored when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1087 'bin' is switched from on to off. Each buffer has its own set of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1088 saved option values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1089 To edit a file with 'binary' set you can use the |++bin| argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1090 This avoids you have to do ":set bin", which would have effect for all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1091 files you edit.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1092 When writing a file the <EOL> for the last line is only written if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1093 there was one in the original file (normally Vim appends an <EOL> to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1094 the last line if there is none; this would make the file longer). See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1095 the 'endofline' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1096
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1097 *'bioskey'* *'biosk'* *'nobioskey'* *'nobiosk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1098 'bioskey' 'biosk' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1099 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1100 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
446
7472c565592a updated for version 7.0117
vimboss
parents: 438
diff changeset
1101 When on the BIOS is called to obtain a keyboard character. This works
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1102 better to detect CTRL-C, but only works for the console. When using a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1103 terminal over a serial port reset this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1104 Also see |'conskey'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1105
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1106 *'bomb'* *'nobomb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1107 'bomb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1108 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1109 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1110 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1111 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1112 When writing a file and the following conditions are met, a BOM (Byte
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1113 Order Mark) is prepended to the file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1114 - this option is on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1115 - the 'binary' option is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1116 - 'fileencoding' is "utf-8", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" or one of the little/big
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1117 endian variants.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1118 Some applications use the BOM to recognize the encoding of the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1119 Often used for UCS-2 files on MS-Windows. For other applications it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1120 causes trouble, for example: "cat file1 file2" makes the BOM of file2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1121 appear halfway the resulting file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1122 When Vim reads a file and 'fileencodings' starts with "ucs-bom", a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1123 check for the presence of the BOM is done and 'bomb' set accordingly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1124 Unless 'binary' is set, it is removed from the first line, so that you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1125 don't see it when editing. When you don't change the options, the BOM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1126 will be restored when writing the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1127
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1128 *'breakat'* *'brk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1129 'breakat' 'brk' string (default " ^I!@*-+;:,./?")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1130 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1131 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1132 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1133 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1134 This option lets you choose which characters might cause a line
500
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
1135 break if 'linebreak' is on. Only works for ASCII and also for 8-bit
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
1136 characters when 'encoding' is an 8-bit encoding.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1137
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1138 *'browsedir'* *'bsdir'*
29
ac33b7c03fac updated for version 7.0018
vimboss
parents: 26
diff changeset
1139 'browsedir' 'bsdir' string (default: "last")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1140 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1141 {not in Vi} {only for Motif and Win32 GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1142 Which directory to use for the file browser:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1143 last Use same directory as with last file browser.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1144 buffer Use the directory of the related buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1145 current Use the current directory.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1146 {path} Use the specified directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1147
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1148 *'bufhidden'* *'bh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1149 'bufhidden' 'bh' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1150 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1151 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1152 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1153 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1154 This option specifies what happens when a buffer is no longer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1155 displayed in a window:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1156 <empty> follow the global 'hidden' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1157 hide hide the buffer (don't unload it), also when 'hidden'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1158 is not set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1159 unload unload the buffer, also when 'hidden' is set or using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1160 |:hide|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1161 delete delete the buffer from the buffer list, also when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1162 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1163 |:bdelete|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1164 wipe wipe out the buffer from the buffer list, also when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1165 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1166 |:bwipeout|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1167
82
366d9947baf2 updated for version 7.0033
vimboss
parents: 75
diff changeset
1168 CAREFUL: when "unload", "delete" or "wipe" is used changes in a buffer
366d9947baf2 updated for version 7.0033
vimboss
parents: 75
diff changeset
1169 are lost without a warning.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1170 This option is used together with 'buftype' and 'swapfile' to specify
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1171 special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1172
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1173 *'buflisted'* *'bl'* *'nobuflisted'* *'nobl'* *E85*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1174 'buflisted' 'bl' boolean (default: on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1175 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1176 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1177 When this option is set, the buffer shows up in the buffer list. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1178 it is reset it is not used for ":bnext", "ls", the Buffers menu, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1179 This option is reset by Vim for buffers that are only used to remember
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1180 a file name or marks. Vim sets it when starting to edit a buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1181 But not when moving to a buffer with ":buffer".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1182
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1183 *'buftype'* *'bt'* *E382*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1184 'buftype' 'bt' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1185 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1186 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1187 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1188 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1189 The value of this option specifies the type of a buffer:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1190 <empty> normal buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1191 nofile buffer which is not related to a file and will not be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1192 written
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1193 nowrite buffer which will not be written
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1194 acwrite buffer which will always be written with BufWriteCmd
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1195 autocommands. {not available when compiled without the
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1196 |+autocmd| feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1197 quickfix quickfix buffer, contains list of errors |:cwindow|
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1198 or list of locations |:lwindow|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1199 help help buffer (you are not supposed to set this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1200 manually)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1201
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1202 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'swapfile' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1203 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1204
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1205 Be careful with changing this option, it can have many side effects!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1206
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1207 A "quickfix" buffer is only used for the error list and the location
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1208 list. This value is set by the |:cwindow| and |:lwindow| commands and
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1209 you are not supposed to change it.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1210
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1211 "nofile" and "nowrite" buffers are similar:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1212 both: The buffer is not to be written to disk, ":w" doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1213 work (":w filename" does work though).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1214 both: The buffer is never considered to be |'modified'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1215 There is no warning when the changes will be lost, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1216 example when you quit Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1217 both: A swap file is only created when using too much memory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1218 (when 'swapfile' has been reset there is never a swap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1219 file).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1220 nofile only: The buffer name is fixed, it is not handled like a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1221 file name. It is not modified in response to a |:cd|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1222 command.
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1223 *E676*
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1224 "acwrite" implies that the buffer name is not related to a file, like
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1225 "nofile", but it will be written. Thus, in contrast to "nofile" and
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1226 "nowrite", ":w" does work and a modified buffer can't be abandoned
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1227 without saving. For writing there must be matching |BufWriteCmd|,
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1228 |FileWriteCmd| or |FileAppendCmd| autocommands.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1229
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1230 *'casemap'* *'cmp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1231 'casemap' 'cmp' string (default: "internal,keepascii")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1232 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1233 {not in Vi}
804
db73a88f4c2d updated for version 7.0b01
vimboss
parents: 799
diff changeset
1234 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
db73a88f4c2d updated for version 7.0b01
vimboss
parents: 799
diff changeset
1235 feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1236 Specifies details about changing the case of letters. It may contain
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1237 these words, separated by a comma:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1238 internal Use internal case mapping functions, the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1239 locale does not change the case mapping. This only
493
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1240 matters when 'encoding' is a Unicode encoding,
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1241 "latin1" or "iso-8859-15". When "internal" is
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1242 omitted, the towupper() and towlower() system library
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1243 functions are used when available.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1244 keepascii For the ASCII characters (0x00 to 0x7f) use the US
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1245 case mapping, the current locale is not effective.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1246 This probably only matters for Turkish.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1247
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1248 *'cdpath'* *'cd'* *E344* *E346*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1249 'cdpath' 'cd' string (default: equivalent to $CDPATH or ",,")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1250 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1251 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1252 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1253 |+file_in_path| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1254 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1255 |:cd| and |:lcd| commands, provided that the directory being searched
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1256 for has a relative path (not starting with "/", "./" or "../").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1257 The 'cdpath' option's value has the same form and semantics as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1258 |'path'|. Also see |file-searching|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1259 The default value is taken from $CDPATH, with a "," prepended to look
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1260 in the current directory first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1261 If the default value taken from $CDPATH is not what you want, include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1262 a modified version of the following command in your vimrc file to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1263 override it: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1264 :let &cdpath = ',' . substitute(substitute($CDPATH, '[, ]', '\\\0', 'g'), ':', ',', 'g')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1265 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1266 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1267 (parts of 'cdpath' can be passed to the shell to expand file names).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1268
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1269 *'cedit'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1270 'cedit' string (Vi default: "", Vim default: CTRL-F)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1271 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1272 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1273 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1274 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1275 The key used in Command-line Mode to open the command-line window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1276 The default is CTRL-F when 'compatible' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1277 Only non-printable keys are allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1278 The key can be specified as a single character, but it is difficult to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1279 type. The preferred way is to use the <> notation. Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1280 :set cedit=<C-Y>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1281 :set cedit=<Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1282 < |Nvi| also has this option, but it only uses the first character.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1283 See |cmdwin|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1284
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1285 *'charconvert'* *'ccv'* *E202* *E214* *E513*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1286 'charconvert' 'ccv' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1287 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1288 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1289 feature and the |+eval| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1290 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1291 An expression that is used for character encoding conversion. It is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1292 evaluated when a file that is to be read or has been written has a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1293 different encoding from what is desired.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1294 'charconvert' is not used when the internal iconv() function is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1295 supported and is able to do the conversion. Using iconv() is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1296 preferred, because it is much faster.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1297 'charconvert' is not used when reading stdin |--|, because there is no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1298 file to convert from. You will have to save the text in a file first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1299 The expression must return zero or an empty string for success,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1300 non-zero for failure.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1301 The possible encoding names encountered are in 'encoding'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1302 Additionally, names given in 'fileencodings' and 'fileencoding' are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1303 used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1304 Conversion between "latin1", "unicode", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" and "utf-8"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1305 is done internally by Vim, 'charconvert' is not used for this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1306 'charconvert' is also used to convert the viminfo file, if the 'c'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1307 flag is present in 'viminfo'. Also used for Unicode conversion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1308 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1309 set charconvert=CharConvert()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1310 fun CharConvert()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1311 system("recode "
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1312 \ . v:charconvert_from . ".." . v:charconvert_to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1313 \ . " <" . v:fname_in . " >" v:fname_out)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1314 return v:shell_error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1315 endfun
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1316 < The related Vim variables are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1317 v:charconvert_from name of the current encoding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1318 v:charconvert_to name of the desired encoding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1319 v:fname_in name of the input file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1320 v:fname_out name of the output file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1321 Note that v:fname_in and v:fname_out will never be the same.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1322 Note that v:charconvert_from and v:charconvert_to may be different
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1323 from 'encoding'. Vim internally uses UTF-8 instead of UCS-2 or UCS-4.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1324 Encryption is not done by Vim when using 'charconvert'. If you want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1325 to encrypt the file after conversion, 'charconvert' should take care
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1326 of this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1327 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1328 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1329
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1330 *'cindent'* *'cin'* *'nocindent'* *'nocin'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1331 'cindent' 'cin' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1332 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1333 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1334 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1335 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1336 Enables automatic C program indenting See 'cinkeys' to set the keys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1337 that trigger reindenting in insert mode and 'cinoptions' to set your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1338 preferred indent style.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1339 If 'indentexpr' is not empty, it overrules 'cindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1340 If 'lisp' is not on and both 'indentexpr' and 'equalprg' are empty,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1341 the "=" operator indents using this algorithm rather than calling an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1342 external program.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1343 See |C-indenting|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1344 When you don't like the way 'cindent' works, try the 'smartindent'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1345 option or 'indentexpr'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1346 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1347 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1348
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1349 *'cinkeys'* *'cink'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1350 'cinkeys' 'cink' string (default "0{,0},0),:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1351 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1352 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1353 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1354 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1355 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1356 the current line. Only used if 'cindent' is on and 'indentexpr' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1357 empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1358 For the format of this option see |cinkeys-format|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1359 See |C-indenting|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1360
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1361 *'cinoptions'* *'cino'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1362 'cinoptions' 'cino' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1363 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1364 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1365 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1366 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1367 The 'cinoptions' affect the way 'cindent' reindents lines in a C
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1368 program. See |cinoptions-values| for the values of this option, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1369 |C-indenting| for info on C indenting in general.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1370
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1371
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1372 *'cinwords'* *'cinw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1373 'cinwords' 'cinw' string (default "if,else,while,do,for,switch")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1374 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1375 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1376 {not available when compiled without both the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1377 |+cindent| and the |+smartindent| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1378 These keywords start an extra indent in the next line when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1379 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is set. For 'cindent' this is only done at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1380 an appropriate place (inside {}).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1381 Note that 'ignorecase' isn't used for 'cinwords'. If case doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1382 matter, include the keyword both the uppercase and lowercase:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1383 "if,If,IF".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1384
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1385 *'clipboard'* *'cb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1386 'clipboard' 'cb' string (default "autoselect,exclude:cons\|linux"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1387 for X-windows, "" otherwise)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1388 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1389 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1390 {only in GUI versions or when the |+xterm_clipboard|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1391 feature is included}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1392 This option is a list of comma separated names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1393 These names are recognized:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1394
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1395 unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1396 for all yank, delete, change and put operations which
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1397 would normally go to the unnamed register. When a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1398 register is explicitly specified, it will always be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1399 used regardless of whether "unnamed" is in 'clipboard'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1400 or not. The clipboard register can always be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1401 explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1402 |gui-clipboard|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1403
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1404 autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1405 then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1406 area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1407 windowing system's global selection or put the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1408 selected text on the clipboard used by the selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1409 register "*. See |guioptions_a| and |quotestar| for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1410 details. When the GUI is active, the 'a' flag in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1411 'guioptions' is used, when the GUI is not active, this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1412 "autoselect" flag is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1413 Also applies to the modeless selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1414
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1415 autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1416 only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1417
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1418 exclude:{pattern}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1419 Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1420 the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1421 connection will be made to the X server. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1422 useful in this situation:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1423 - Running Vim in a console.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1424 - $DISPLAY is set to start applications on another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1425 display.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1426 - You do not want to connect to the X server in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1427 console, but do want this in a terminal emulator.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1428 To never connect to the X server use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1429 exclude:.*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1430 < This has the same effect as using the |-X| argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1431 Note that when there is no connection to the X server
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1432 the window title won't be restored and the clipboard
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1433 cannot be accessed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1434 The value of 'magic' is ignored, {pattern} is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1435 interpreted as if 'magic' was on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1436 The rest of the option value will be used for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1437 {pattern}, this must be the last entry.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1438
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1439 *'cmdheight'* *'ch'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1440 'cmdheight' 'ch' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1441 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1442 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1443 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line. Helps avoiding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1444 |hit-enter| prompts.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1445
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1446 *'cmdwinheight'* *'cwh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1447 'cmdwinheight' 'cwh' number (default 7)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1448 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1449 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1450 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1451 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1452 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line window. |cmdwin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1453
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1454 *'columns'* *'co'* *E594*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1455 'columns' 'co' number (default 80 or terminal width)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1456 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1457 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1458 Number of columns of the screen. Normally this is set by the terminal
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1459 initialization and does not have to be set by hand. Also see
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1460 |posix-screen-size|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1461 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1462 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1463 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1464 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1465 number of columns of the display, the display may be messed up.
571
0ae54f30d5bc updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 557
diff changeset
1466 Mimimum value is 12, maximum value is 10000.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1467
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1468 *'comments'* *'com'* *E524* *E525*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1469 'comments' 'com' string (default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1470 "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,://,b:#,:%,:XCOMM,n:>,fb:-")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1471 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1472 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1473 {not available when compiled without the |+comments|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1474 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1475 A comma separated list of strings that can start a comment line. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1476 |format-comments|. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1477 insert a space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1478
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1479 *'commentstring'* *'cms'* *E537*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1480 'commentstring' 'cms' string (default "/*%s*/")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1481 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1482 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1483 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1484 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1485 A template for a comment. The "%s" in the value is replaced with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1486 comment text. Currently only used to add markers for folding, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1487 |fold-marker|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1488
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1489 *'compatible'* *'cp'* *'nocompatible'* *'nocp'*
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
1490 'compatible' 'cp' boolean (default on, off when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc|
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
1491 file is found)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1492 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1493 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1494 This option has the effect of making Vim either more Vi-compatible, or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1495 make Vim behave in a more useful way.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1496 This is a special kind of option, because when it's set or reset,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1497 other options are also changed as a side effect. CAREFUL: Setting or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1498 resetting this option can have a lot of unexpected effects: Mappings
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1499 are interpreted in another way, undo behaves differently, etc. If you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1500 set this option in your vimrc file, you should probably put it at the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1501 very start.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1502 By default this option is on and the Vi defaults are used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1503 options. This default was chosen for those people who want to use Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1504 just like Vi, and don't even (want to) know about the 'compatible'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1505 option.
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
1506 When a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file is found while Vim is starting up,
378
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1507 this option is switched off, and all options that have not been
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1508 modified will be set to the Vim defaults. Effectively, this means
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
1509 that when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file exists, Vim will use the Vim
378
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1510 defaults, otherwise it will use the Vi defaults. (Note: This doesn't
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1511 happen for the system-wide vimrc or gvimrc file). Also see
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1512 |compatible-default| and |posix-compliance|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1513 You can also set this option with the "-C" argument, and reset it with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1514 "-N". See |-C| and |-N|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1515 Switching this option off makes the Vim defaults be used for options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1516 that have a different Vi and Vim default value. See the options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1517 marked with a '+' below. Other options are not modified.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1518 At the moment this option is set, several other options will be set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1519 or reset to make Vim as Vi-compatible as possible. See the table
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1520 below. This can be used if you want to revert to Vi compatible
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1521 editing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1522 See also 'cpoptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1523
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1524 option + set value effect ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1525
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1526 'allowrevins' off no CTRL-_ command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1527 'backupcopy' Unix: "yes" backup file is a copy
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1528 others: "auto" copy or rename backup file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1529 'backspace' "" normal backspace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1530 'backup' off no backup file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1531 'cindent' off no C code indentation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1532 'cedit' + "" no key to open the |cmdwin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1533 'cpoptions' + (all flags) Vi-compatible flags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1534 'cscopetag' off don't use cscope for ":tag"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1535 'cscopetagorder' 0 see |cscopetagorder|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1536 'cscopeverbose' off see |cscopeverbose|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1537 'digraph' off no digraphs
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1538 'esckeys' + off no <Esc>-keys in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1539 'expandtab' off tabs not expanded to spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1540 'fileformats' + "" no automatic file format detection,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1541 "dos,unix" except for DOS, Windows and OS/2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1542 'formatoptions' + "vt" Vi compatible formatting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1543 'gdefault' off no default 'g' flag for ":s"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1544 'history' + 0 no commandline history
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1545 'hkmap' off no Hebrew keyboard mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1546 'hkmapp' off no phonetic Hebrew keyboard mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1547 'hlsearch' off no highlighting of search matches
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1548 'incsearch' off no incremental searching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1549 'indentexpr' "" no indenting by expression
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1550 'insertmode' off do not start in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1551 'iskeyword' + "@,48-57,_" keywords contain alphanumeric
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1552 characters and '_'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1553 'joinspaces' on insert 2 spaces after period
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1554 'modeline' + off no modelines
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1555 'more' + off no pauses in listings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1556 'revins' off no reverse insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1557 'ruler' off no ruler
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1558 'scrolljump' 1 no jump scroll
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1559 'scrolloff' 0 no scroll offset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1560 'shiftround' off indent not rounded to shiftwidth
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1561 'shortmess' + "" no shortening of messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1562 'showcmd' + off command characters not shown
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1563 'showmode' + off current mode not shown
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1564 'smartcase' off no automatic ignore case switch
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1565 'smartindent' off no smart indentation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1566 'smarttab' off no smart tab size
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1567 'softtabstop' 0 tabs are always 'tabstop' positions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1568 'startofline' on goto startofline with some commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1569 'tagrelative' + off tag file names are not relative
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1570 'textauto' + off no automatic textmode detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1571 'textwidth' 0 no automatic line wrap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1572 'tildeop' off tilde is not an operator
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1573 'ttimeout' off no terminal timeout
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1574 'whichwrap' + "" left-right movements don't wrap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1575 'wildchar' + CTRL-E only when the current value is <Tab>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1576 use CTRL-E for cmdline completion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1577 'writebackup' on or off depends on +writebackup feature
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1578
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1579 *'complete'* *'cpt'* *E535*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1580 'complete' 'cpt' string (default: ".,w,b,u,t,i")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1581 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1582 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1583 This option specifies how keyword completion |ins-completion| works
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1584 when CTRL-P or CTRL-N are used. It is also used for whole-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1585 completion |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|. It indicates the type of completion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1586 and the places to scan. It is a comma separated list of flags:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1587 . scan the current buffer ('wrapscan' is ignored)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1588 w scan buffers from other windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1589 b scan other loaded buffers that are in the buffer list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1590 u scan the unloaded buffers that are in the buffer list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1591 U scan the buffers that are not in the buffer list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1592 k scan the files given with the 'dictionary' option
703
2fae45239fb3 updated for version 7.0212
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
1593 kspell use the currently active spell checking |spell|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1594 k{dict} scan the file {dict}. Several "k" flags can be given,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1595 patterns are valid too. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1596 :set cpt=k/usr/dict/*,k~/spanish
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1597 < s scan the files given with the 'thesaurus' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1598 s{tsr} scan the file {tsr}. Several "s" flags can be given, patterns
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1599 are valid too.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1600 i scan current and included files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1601 d scan current and included files for defined name or macro
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1602 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-D|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1603 ] tag completion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1604 t same as "]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1605
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1606 Unloaded buffers are not loaded, thus their autocmds |:autocmd| are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1607 not executed, this may lead to unexpected completions from some files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1608 (gzipped files for example). Unloaded buffers are not scanned for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1609 whole-line completion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1610
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1611 The default is ".,w,b,u,t,i", which means to scan:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1612 1. the current buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1613 2. buffers in other windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1614 3. other loaded buffers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1615 4. unloaded buffers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1616 5. tags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1617 6. included files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1618
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1619 As you can see, CTRL-N and CTRL-P can be used to do any 'iskeyword'-
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
1620 based expansion (e.g., dictionary |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|, included patterns
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
1621 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-I|, tags |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-]| and normal expansions).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1622
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1623 *'completefunc'* *'cfu'*
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1624 'completefunc' 'cfu' string (default: empty)
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1625 local to buffer
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1626 {not in Vi}
452
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1627 {not available when compiled without the +eval
01af1008a8d8 updated for version 7.0120
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
1628 or +insert_expand feature}
623
bd2fe62c9d77 updated for version 7.0178
vimboss
parents: 596
diff changeset
1629 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode completion
bd2fe62c9d77 updated for version 7.0178
vimboss
parents: 596
diff changeset
1630 with CTRL-X CTRL-U. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U|
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1631 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1632 invoked and what it should return.
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1633
14
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
1634
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1635 *'completeopt'* *'cot'*
730
44348703ab1b updated for version 7.0221
vimboss
parents: 717
diff changeset
1636 'completeopt' 'cot' string (default: "menu,preview")
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1637 global
766
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
1638 {not available when compiled without the
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
1639 |+insert_expand| feature}
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1640 {not in Vi}
665
21ab9abf0f08 updated for version 7.0196
vimboss
parents: 657
diff changeset
1641 A comma separated list of options for Insert mode completion
21ab9abf0f08 updated for version 7.0196
vimboss
parents: 657
diff changeset
1642 |ins-completion|. The supported values are:
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1643
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1644 menu Use a popup menu to show the possible completions. The
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1645 menu is only shown when there is more than one match and
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1646 sufficient colors are available. |ins-completion-menu|
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1647
707
111b7dcc8a17 updated for version 7.0213
vimboss
parents: 703
diff changeset
1648 menuone Use the popup menu also when there is only one match.
111b7dcc8a17 updated for version 7.0213
vimboss
parents: 703
diff changeset
1649 Useful when there is additional information about the
111b7dcc8a17 updated for version 7.0213
vimboss
parents: 703
diff changeset
1650 match, e.g., what file it comes from.
111b7dcc8a17 updated for version 7.0213
vimboss
parents: 703
diff changeset
1651
665
21ab9abf0f08 updated for version 7.0196
vimboss
parents: 657
diff changeset
1652 longest Only insert the longest common text of the matches. Use
730
44348703ab1b updated for version 7.0221
vimboss
parents: 717
diff changeset
1653 CTRL-L to add more characters. Whether case is ignored
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
1654 depends on the kind of completion. For buffer text the
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
1655 'ignorecase' option is used.
665
21ab9abf0f08 updated for version 7.0196
vimboss
parents: 657
diff changeset
1656
730
44348703ab1b updated for version 7.0221
vimboss
parents: 717
diff changeset
1657 preview Show extra information about the currently selected
44348703ab1b updated for version 7.0221
vimboss
parents: 717
diff changeset
1658 completion in the preview window.
44348703ab1b updated for version 7.0221
vimboss
parents: 717
diff changeset
1659
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1660 *'confirm'* *'cf'* *'noconfirm'* *'nocf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1661 'confirm' 'cf' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1662 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1663 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1664 When 'confirm' is on, certain operations that would normally
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1665 fail because of unsaved changes to a buffer, e.g. ":q" and ":e",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1666 instead raise a |dialog| asking if you wish to save the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1667 file(s). You can still use a ! to unconditionally |abandon| a buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1668 If 'confirm' is off you can still activate confirmation for one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1669 command only (this is most useful in mappings) with the |:confirm|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1670 command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1671 Also see the |confirm()| function and the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1672
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1673 *'conskey'* *'consk'* *'noconskey'* *'noconsk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1674 'conskey' 'consk' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1675 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1676 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1677 When on direct console I/O is used to obtain a keyboard character.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1678 This should work in most cases. Also see |'bioskey'|. Together,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1679 three methods of console input are available:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1680 'conskey' 'bioskey' action ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1681 on on or off direct console input
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1682 off on BIOS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1683 off off STDIN
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1684
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1685 *'copyindent'* *'ci'* *'nocopyindent'* *'noci'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1686 'copyindent' 'ci' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1687 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1688 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1689 Copy the structure of the existing lines indent when autoindenting a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1690 new line. Normally the new indent is reconstructed by a series of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1691 tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is enabled,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1692 in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option makes the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1693 new line copy whatever characters were used for indenting on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1694 existing line. If the new indent is greater than on the existing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1695 line, the remaining space is filled in the normal manner.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1696 NOTE: 'copyindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1697 Also see 'preserveindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1698
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1699 *'cpoptions'* *'cpo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1700 'cpoptions' 'cpo' string (Vim default: "aABceFs",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1701 Vi default: all flags)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1702 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1703 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1704 A sequence of single character flags. When a character is present
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1705 this indicates vi-compatible behavior. This is used for things where
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1706 not being vi-compatible is mostly or sometimes preferred.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1707 'cpoptions' stands for "compatible-options".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1708 Commas can be added for readability.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1709 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1710 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1711 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1712 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1713 NOTE: This option is set to the POSIX default value at startup when
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1714 the Vi default value would be used and the $VIM_POSIX environment
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1715 variable exists |posix|. This means tries to behave like the POSIX
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1716 specification.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1717
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1718 contains behavior ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1719 *cpo-a*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1720 a When included, a ":read" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1721 argument will set the alternate file name for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1722 current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1723 *cpo-A*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1724 A When included, a ":write" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1725 argument will set the alternate file name for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1726 current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1727 *cpo-b*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1728 b "\|" in a ":map" command is recognized as the end of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1729 the map command. The '\' is included in the mapping,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1730 the text after the '|' is interpreted as the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1731 command. Use a CTRL-V instead of a backslash to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1732 include the '|' in the mapping. Applies to all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1733 mapping, abbreviation, menu and autocmd commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1734 See also |map_bar|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1735 *cpo-B*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1736 B A backslash has no special meaning in mappings,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1737 abbreviations and the "to" part of the menu commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1738 Remove this flag to be able to use a backslash like a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1739 CTRL-V. For example, the command ":map X \<Esc>"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1740 results in X being mapped to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1741 'B' included: "\^[" (^[ is a real <Esc>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1742 'B' excluded: "<Esc>" (5 characters)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1743 ('<' excluded in both cases)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1744 *cpo-c*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1745 c Searching continues at the end of any match at the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1746 cursor position, but not further than the start of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1747 next line. When not present searching continues
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1748 one character from the cursor position. With 'c'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1749 "abababababab" only gets three matches when repeating
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1750 "/abab", without 'c' there are five matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1751 *cpo-C*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1752 C Do not concatenate sourced lines that start with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1753 backslash. See |line-continuation|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1754 *cpo-d*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1755 d Using "./" in the 'tags' option doesn't mean to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1756 the tags file relative to the current file, but the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1757 tags file in the current directory.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1758 *cpo-D*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1759 D Can't use CTRL-K to enter a digraph after Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1760 commands with a character argument, like |r|, |f| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1761 |t|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1762 *cpo-e*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1763 e When executing a register with ":@r", always add a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1764 <CR> to the last line, also when the register is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1765 linewise. If this flag is not present, the register
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1766 is not linewise and the last line does not end in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1767 <CR>, then the last line is put on the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1768 and can be edited before hitting <CR>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1769 *cpo-E*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1770 E It is an error when using "y", "d", "c", "g~", "gu" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1771 "gU" on an Empty region. The operators only work when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1772 at least one character is to be operate on. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1773 This makes "y0" fail in the first column.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1774 *cpo-f*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1775 f When included, a ":read" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1776 argument will set the file name for the current buffer,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1777 if the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1778 *cpo-F*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1779 F When included, a ":write" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1780 argument will set the file name for the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1781 buffer, if the current buffer doesn't have a file name
590
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
1782 yet. Also see |cpo-P|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1783 *cpo-g*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1784 g Goto line 1 when using ":edit" without argument.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1785 *cpo-H*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1786 H When using "I" on a line with only blanks, insert
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1787 before the last blank. Without this flag insert after
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1788 the last blank.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1789 *cpo-i*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1790 i When included, interrupting the reading of a file will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1791 leave it modified.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1792 *cpo-I*
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1793 I When moving the cursor up or down just after inserting
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1794 indent for 'autoindent', do not delete the indent.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1795 *cpo-j*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1796 j When joining lines, only add two spaces after a '.',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1797 not after '!' or '?'. Also see 'joinspaces'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1798 *cpo-J*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1799 J A |sentence| has to be followed by two spaces after
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
1800 the '.', '!' or '?'. A <Tab> is not recognized as
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1801 white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1802 *cpo-k*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1803 k Disable the recognition of raw key codes in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1804 mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of menu
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1805 commands. For example, if <Key> sends ^[OA (where ^[
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1806 is <Esc>), the command ":map X ^[OA" results in X
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1807 being mapped to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1808 'k' included: "^[OA" (3 characters)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1809 'k' excluded: "<Key>" (one key code)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1810 Also see the '<' flag below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1811 *cpo-K*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1812 K Don't wait for a key code to complete when it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1813 halfway a mapping. This breaks mapping <F1><F1> when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1814 only part of the second <F1> has been read. It
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1815 enables cancelling the mapping by typing <F1><Esc>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1816 *cpo-l*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1817 l Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1818 literally, only "\]", "\^", "\-" and "\\" are special.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1819 See |/[]|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1820 'l' included: "/[ \t]" finds <Space>, '\' and 't'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1821 'l' excluded: "/[ \t]" finds <Space> and <Tab>
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1822 Also see |cpo-\|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1823 *cpo-L*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1824 L When the 'list' option is set, 'wrapmargin',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1825 'textwidth', 'softtabstop' and Virtual Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1826 (see |gR|) count a <Tab> as two characters, instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1827 the normal behavior of a <Tab>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1828 *cpo-m*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1829 m When included, a showmatch will always wait half a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1830 second. When not included, a showmatch will wait half
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1831 a second or until a character is typed. |'showmatch'|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1832 *cpo-M*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1833 M When excluded, "%" matching will take backslashes into
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1834 account. Thus in "( \( )" and "\( ( \)" the outer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1835 parenthesis match. When included "%" ignores
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1836 backslashes, which is Vi compatible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1837 *cpo-n*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1838 n When included, the column used for 'number' will also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1839 be used for text of wrapped lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1840 *cpo-o*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1841 o Line offset to search command is not remembered for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1842 next search.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1843 *cpo-O*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1844 O Don't complain if a file is being overwritten, even
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1845 when it didn't exist when editing it. This is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1846 protection against a file unexpectedly created by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1847 someone else. Vi didn't complain about this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1848 *cpo-p*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1849 p Vi compatible Lisp indenting. When not present, a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1850 slightly better algorithm is used.
590
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
1851 *cpo-P*
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
1852 P When included, a ":write" command that appends to a
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
1853 file will set the file name for the current buffer, if
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
1854 the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet and
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
1855 the 'F' flag is also included |cpo-F|.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1856 *cpo-q*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1857 q When joining multiple lines leave the cursor at the
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1858 position where it would be when joining two lines.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1859 *cpo-r*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1860 r Redo ("." command) uses "/" to repeat a search
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1861 command, instead of the actually used search string.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1862 *cpo-R*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1863 R Remove marks from filtered lines. Without this flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1864 marks are kept like |:keepmarks| was used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1865 *cpo-s*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1866 s Set buffer options when entering the buffer for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1867 first time. This is like it is in Vim version 3.0.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1868 And it is the default. If not present the options are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1869 set when the buffer is created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1870 *cpo-S*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1871 S Set buffer options always when entering a buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1872 (except 'readonly', 'fileformat', 'filetype' and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1873 'syntax'). This is the (most) Vi compatible setting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1874 The options are set to the values in the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1875 buffer. When you change an option and go to another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1876 buffer, the value is copied. Effectively makes the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1877 buffer options global to all buffers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1878
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1879 's' 'S' copy buffer options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1880 no no when buffer created
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1881 yes no when buffer first entered (default)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1882 X yes each time when buffer entered (vi comp.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1883 *cpo-t*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1884 t Search pattern for the tag command is remembered for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1885 "n" command. Otherwise Vim only puts the pattern in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1886 the history for search pattern, but doesn't change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1887 last used search pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1888 *cpo-u*
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1889 u Undo is Vi compatible. See |undo-two-ways|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1890 *cpo-v*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1891 v Backspaced characters remain visible on the screen in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1892 Insert mode. Without this flag the characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1893 erased from the screen right away. With this flag the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1894 screen newly typed text overwrites backspaced
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1895 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1896 *cpo-w*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1897 w When using "cw" on a blank character, only change one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1898 character and not all blanks until the start of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1899 next word.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1900 *cpo-W*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1901 W Don't overwrite a readonly file. When omitted, ":w!"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1902 overwrites a readonly file, if possible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1903 *cpo-x*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1904 x <Esc> on the command-line executes the command-line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1905 The default in Vim is to abandon the command-line,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1906 because <Esc> normally aborts a command. |c_<Esc>|
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1907 *cpo-X*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1908 X When using a count with "R" the replaced text is
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1909 deleted only once. Also when repeating "R" with "."
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1910 and a count.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1911 *cpo-y*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1912 y A yank command can be redone with ".".
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1913 *cpo-Z*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1914 Z When using "w!" while the 'readonly' option is set,
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1915 don't reset 'readonly'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1916 *cpo-!*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1917 ! When redoing a filter command, use the last used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1918 external command, whatever it was. Otherwise the last
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1919 used -filter- command is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1920 *cpo-$*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1921 $ When making a change to one line, don't redisplay the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1922 line, but put a '$' at the end of the changed text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1923 The changed text will be overwritten when you type the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1924 new text. The line is redisplayed if you type any
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1925 command that moves the cursor from the insertion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1926 point.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1927 *cpo-%*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1928 % Vi-compatible matching is done for the "%" command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1929 Does not recognize "#if", "#endif", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1930 Does not recognize "/*" and "*/".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1931 Parens inside single and double quotes are also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1932 counted, causing a string that contains a paren to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1933 disturb the matching. For example, in a line like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1934 "if (strcmp("foo(", s))" the first paren does not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1935 match the last one. When this flag is not included,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1936 parens inside single and double quotes are treated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1937 specially. When matching a paren outside of quotes,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1938 everything inside quotes is ignored. When matching a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1939 paren inside quotes, it will find the matching one (if
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1940 there is one). This works very well for C programs.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
1941 This flag is also used for other features, such as
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
1942 C-indenting.
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1943 *cpo--*
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1944 - When included, a vertical movement command fails when
632
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
1945 it would go above the first line or below the last
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
1946 line. Without it the cursor moves to the first or
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
1947 last line, unless it already was in that line.
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1948 Applies to the commands "-", "k", CTRL-P, "+", "j",
632
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
1949 CTRL-N, CTRL-J and ":1234".
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
1950 *cpo-+*
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
1951 + When included, a ":write file" command will reset the
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
1952 'modified' flag of the buffer, even though the buffer
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
1953 itself may still be different from its file.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1954 *cpo-star*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1955 * Use ":*" in the same way as ":@". When not included,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1956 ":*" is an alias for ":'<,'>", select the Visual area.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1957 *cpo-<*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1958 < Disable the recognition of special key codes in |<>|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1959 form in mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1960 menu commands. For example, the command
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1961 ":map X <Tab>" results in X being mapped to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1962 '<' included: "<Tab>" (5 characters)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1963 '<' excluded: "^I" (^I is a real <Tab>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1964 Also see the 'k' flag above.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1965 *cpo->*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1966 > When appending to a register, put a line break before
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1967 the appended text.
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1968
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1969 POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1970 when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix|
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1971
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1972 contains behavior ~
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1973 *cpo-#*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1974 # A count before "D", "o" and "O" has no effect.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1975 *cpo-&*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1976 & When ":preserve" was used keep the swap file when
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1977 exiting normally while this buffer is still loaded.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1978 This flag is tested when exiting.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1979 *cpo-\*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1980 \ Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1981 literally, only "\]" is special See |/[]|
488
f00f0af2a320 updated for version 7.0133
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1982 '\' included: "/[ \-]" finds <Space>, '\' and '-'
f00f0af2a320 updated for version 7.0133
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1983 '\' excluded: "/[ \-]" finds <Space> and '-'
f00f0af2a320 updated for version 7.0133
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1984 Also see |cpo-l|.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1985 *cpo-/*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1986 / When "%" is used as the replacement string in a |:s|
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1987 command, use the previous replacement string. |:s%|
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1988 *cpo-{*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1989 { The |{| and |}| commands also stop at a "{" character
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1990 at the start of a line.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1991 *cpo-.*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1992 . The ":chdir" and ":cd" commands fail if the current
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1993 buffer is modified, unless ! is used. Vim doesn't
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1994 need this, since it remembers the full path of an
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1995 opened file.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1996 *cpo-bar*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1997 | The value of the $LINES and $COLUMNS environment
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1998 variables overrule the terminal size values obtained
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1999 with system specific functions.
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2000
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2001
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2002 *'cscopepathcomp'* *'cspc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2003 'cscopepathcomp' 'cspc' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2004 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2005 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2006 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2007 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2008 Determines how many components of the path to show in a list of tags.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2009 See |cscopepathcomp|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2010
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2011 *'cscopeprg'* *'csprg'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2012 'cscopeprg' 'csprg' string (default "cscope")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2013 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2014 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2015 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2016 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2017 Specifies the command to execute cscope. See |cscopeprg|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2018 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2019 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2020
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2021 *'cscopequickfix'* *'csqf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2022 'cscopequickfix' 'csqf' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2023 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2024 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2025 or |+quickfix| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2026 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2027 Specifies whether to use quickfix window to show cscope results.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2028 See |cscopequickfix|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2029
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2030 *'cscopetag'* *'cst'* *'nocscopetag'* *'nocst'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2031 'cscopetag' 'cst' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2032 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2033 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2034 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2035 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2036 Use cscope for tag commands. See |cscope-options|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2037 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2038
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2039 *'cscopetagorder'* *'csto'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2040 'cscopetagorder' 'csto' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2041 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2042 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2043 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2044 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2045 Determines the order in which ":cstag" performs a search. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2046 |cscopetagorder|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2047 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2048
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2049 *'cscopeverbose'* *'csverb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2050 *'nocscopeverbose'* *'nocsverb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2051 'cscopeverbose' 'csverb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2052 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2053 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2054 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2055 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2056 Give messages when adding a cscope database. See |cscopeverbose|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2057 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2058
743
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2059
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2060 *'cursorcolumn'* *'cuc'* *'nocursorcolumn'* *'nocuc'*
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2061 'cursorcolumn' 'cuc' boolean (default off)
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2062 local to window
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2063 {not in Vi}
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2064 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2065 feature}
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2066 Highlight the screen column of the cursor with CursorColumn
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2067 |hl-CursorColumn|. Useful to align text. Will make screen redrawing
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2068 slower.
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2069
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2070 *'cursorline'* *'cul'* *'nocursorline'* *'nocul'*
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2071 'cursorline' 'cul' boolean (default off)
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2072 local to window
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2073 {not in Vi}
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2074 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2075 feature}
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2076 Highlight the screen line of the cursor with CursorLine
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2077 |hl-CursorLine|. Useful to easily spot the cursor. Will make screen
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2078 redrawing slower.
818
1f929f3ca806 updated for version 7.0c03
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2079 When Visual mode is active the highlighting isn't used to make it
1f929f3ca806 updated for version 7.0c03
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2080 easier to spot where the selected area.
743
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2081
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2082
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2083 *'debug'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2084 'debug' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2085 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2086 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2087 When set to "msg", error messages that would otherwise be omitted will
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2088 be given anyway. This is useful when debugging 'foldexpr',
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2089 'formatexpr' or 'indentexpr'.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2090 When set to "beep", a message will be given when otherwise only a beep
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2091 would be produced.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2092 The values can be combined, separated by a comma.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2093
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2094 *'define'* *'def'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2095 'define' 'def' string (default "^\s*#\s*define")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2096 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2097 {not in Vi}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2098 Pattern to be used to find a macro definition. It is a search
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2099 pattern, just like for the "/" command. This option is used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2100 commands like "[i" and "[d" |include-search|. The 'isident' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2101 used to recognize the defined name after the match:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2102 {match with 'define'}{non-ID chars}{defined name}{non-ID char}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2103 See |option-backslash| about inserting backslashes to include a space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2104 or backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2105 The default value is for C programs. For C++ this value would be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2106 useful, to include const type declarations: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2107 ^\(#\s*define\|[a-z]*\s*const\s*[a-z]*\)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2108 < When using the ":set" command, you need to double the backslashes!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2109
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2110 *'delcombine'* *'deco'* *'nodelcombine'* *'nodeco'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2111 'delcombine' 'deco' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2112 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2113 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2114 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2115 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2116 If editing Unicode and this option is set, backspace and Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2117 "x" delete each combining character on its own. When it is off (the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2118 default) the character along with its combining characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2119 deleted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2120 Note: When 'delcombine' is set "xx" may work different from "2x"!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2121
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2122 This is useful for Arabic, Hebrew and many other languages where one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2123 may have combining characters overtop of base characters, and want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2124 to remove only the combining ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2125
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2126 *'dictionary'* *'dict'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2127 'dictionary' 'dict' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2128 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2129 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2130 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2131 for keyword completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|. Each file should
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2132 contain a list of words. This can be one word per line, or several
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2133 words per line, separated by non-keyword characters (white space is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2134 preferred). Maximum line length is 510 bytes.
703
2fae45239fb3 updated for version 7.0212
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2135 When this option is empty, or an entry "spell" is present, spell
2fae45239fb3 updated for version 7.0212
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2136 checking is enabled the currently active spelling is used. |spell|
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2137 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2138 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2139 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
99
04f2e519ab18 updated for version 7.0038
vimboss
parents: 82
diff changeset
2140 This has nothing to do with the |Dictionary| variable type.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2141 Where to find a list of words?
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2142 - On FreeBSD, there is the file "/usr/share/dict/words".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2143 - In the Simtel archive, look in the "msdos/linguist" directory.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2144 - In "miscfiles" of the GNU collection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2145 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2146 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2147 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2148 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2149
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2150 *'diff'* *'nodiff'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2151 'diff' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2152 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2153 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2154 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2155 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2156 Join the current window in the group of windows that shows differences
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2157 between files. See |vimdiff|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2158
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2159 *'dex'* *'diffexpr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2160 'diffexpr' 'dex' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2161 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2162 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2163 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2164 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2165 Expression which is evaluated to obtain an ed-style diff file from two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2166 versions of a file. See |diff-diffexpr|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2167 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2168 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2169
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2170 *'dip'* *'diffopt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2171 'diffopt' 'dip' string (default "filler")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2172 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2173 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2174 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2175 feature}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2176 Option settings for diff mode. It can consist of the following items.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2177 All are optional. Items must be separated by a comma.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2178
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2179 filler Show filler lines, to keep the text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2180 synchronized with a window that has inserted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2181 lines at the same position. Mostly useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2182 when windows are side-by-side and 'scrollbind'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2183 is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2184
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2185 context:{n} Use a context of {n} lines between a change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2186 and a fold that contains unchanged lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2187 When omitted a context of six lines is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2188 See |fold-diff|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2189
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2190 icase Ignore changes in case of text. "a" and "A"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2191 are considered the same. Adds the "-i" flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2192 to the "diff" command if 'diffexpr' is empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2193
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2194 iwhite Ignore changes in amount of white space. Adds
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2195 the "-b" flag to the "diff" command if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2196 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2197 of the "diff" command for what this does
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2198 exactly. It should ignore adding trailing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2199 white space, but not leading white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2200
766
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2201 horizontal Start diff mode with horizontal splits (unless
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2202 explicitly specified otherwise).
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2203
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2204 vertical Start diff mode with vertical splits (unless
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2205 explicitly specified otherwise).
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2206
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2207 foldcolumn:{n} Set the 'foldcolumn' option to {n} when
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2208 starting diff mode. Without this 2 is used.
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2209
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2210 Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2211
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2212 :set diffopt=filler,context:4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2213 :set diffopt=
766
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2214 :set diffopt=filler,foldcolumn:3
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2215 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2216 *'digraph'* *'dg'* *'nodigraph'* *'nodg'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2217 'digraph' 'dg' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2218 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2219 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2220 {not available when compiled without the |+digraphs|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2221 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2222 Enable the entering of digraphs in Insert mode with {char1} <BS>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2223 {char2}. See |digraphs|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2224 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2225
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2226 *'directory'* *'dir'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2227 'directory' 'dir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2228 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,c:\tmp,c:\temp"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2229 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,/var/tmp,/tmp")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2230 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2231 List of directory names for the swap file, separated with commas.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2232 - The swap file will be created in the first directory where this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2233 possible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2234 - Empty means that no swap file will be used (recovery is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2235 impossible!).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2236 - A directory "." means to put the swap file in the same directory as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2237 the edited file. On Unix, a dot is prepended to the file name, so
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2238 it doesn't show in a directory listing. On MS-Windows the "hidden"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2239 attribute is set and a dot prepended if possible.
33
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2240 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2241 put the swap file relative to where the edited file is. The leading
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2242 "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
459
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2243 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//"
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2244 or "\\", the swap file name will be built from the complete path to
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2245 the file with all path separators substituted to percent '%' signs.
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2246 This will ensure file name uniqueness in the preserve directory.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2247 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2248 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2249 name, precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2250 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2251 - A directory name may end in an ':' or '/'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2252 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2253 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2254 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2255 :set dir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2256 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2257 of the option is removed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2258 Using "." first in the list is recommended. This means that editing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2259 the same file twice will result in a warning. Using "/tmp" on Unix is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2260 discouraged: When the system crashes you lose the swap file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2261 "/var/tmp" is often not cleared when rebooting, thus is a better
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2262 choice than "/tmp". But it can contain a lot of files, your swap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2263 files get lost in the crowd. That is why a "tmp" directory in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2264 home directory is tried first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2265 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2266 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2267 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2268 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2269 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2270 {Vi: directory to put temp file in, defaults to "/tmp"}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2271
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2272 *'display'* *'dy'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2273 'display' 'dy' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2274 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2275 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2276 Change the way text is displayed. This is comma separated list of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2277 flags:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2278 lastline When included, as much as possible of the last line
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2279 in a window will be displayed. When not included, a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2280 last line that doesn't fit is replaced with "@" lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2281 uhex Show unprintable characters hexadecimal as <xx>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2282 instead of using ^C and ~C.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2283
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2284 *'eadirection'* *'ead'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2285 'eadirection' 'ead' string (default "both")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2286 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2287 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2288 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2289 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2290 Tells when the 'equalalways' option applies:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2291 ver vertically, width of windows is not affected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2292 hor horizontally, height of windows is not affected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2293 both width and height of windows is affected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2294
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2295 *'ed'* *'edcompatible'* *'noed'* *'noedcompatible'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2296 'edcompatible' 'ed' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2297 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2298 Makes the 'g' and 'c' flags of the ":substitute" command to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2299 toggled each time the flag is given. See |complex-change|. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2300 also 'gdefault' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2301 Switching this option on is discouraged!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2302
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2303 *'encoding'* *'enc'* *E543*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2304 'encoding' 'enc' string (default: "latin1" or value from $LANG)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2305 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2306 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2307 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2308 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2309 Sets the character encoding used inside Vim. It applies to text in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2310 the buffers, registers, Strings in expressions, text stored in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2311 viminfo file, etc. It sets the kind of characters which Vim can work
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2312 with. See |encoding-names| for the possible values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2313
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2314 NOTE: Changing this option will not change the encoding of the
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2315 existing text in Vim. It may cause non-ASCII text to become invalid.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2316 It should normally be kept at its default value, or set when Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2317 starts up. See |multibyte|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2318
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2319 NOTE: For GTK+ 2 it is highly recommended to set 'encoding' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2320 "utf-8". Although care has been taken to allow different values of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2321 'encoding', "utf-8" is the natural choice for the environment and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2322 avoids unnecessary conversion overhead. "utf-8" has not been made
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2323 the default to prevent different behavior of the GUI and terminal
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2324 versions, and to avoid changing the encoding of newly created files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2325 without your knowledge (in case 'fileencodings' is empty).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2326
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2327 The character encoding of files can be different from 'encoding'.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2328 This is specified with 'fileencoding'. The conversion is done with
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2329 iconv() or as specified with 'charconvert'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2330
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2331 Normally 'encoding' will be equal to your current locale. This will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2332 be the default if Vim recognizes your environment settings. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2333 'encoding' is not set to the current locale, 'termencoding' must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2334 set to convert typed and displayed text. See |encoding-table|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2335
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2336 When you set this option, it fires the |EncodingChanged| autocommand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2337 event so that you can set up fonts if necessary.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2338
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2339 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2340 you can set it with uppercase values too. Underscores are translated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2341 to '-' signs.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2342 When the encoding is recognized, it is changed to the standard name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2343 For example "Latin-1" becomes "latin1", "ISO_88592" becomes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2344 "iso-8859-2" and "utf8" becomes "utf-8".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2345
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2346 Note: "latin1" is also used when the encoding could not be detected.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2347 This only works when editing files in the same encoding! When the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2348 actual character set is not latin1, make sure 'fileencoding' and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2349 'fileencodings' are empty. When conversion is needed, switch to using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2350 utf-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2351
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2352 When "unicode", "ucs-2" or "ucs-4" is used, Vim internally uses utf-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2353 You don't notice this while editing, but it does matter for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2354 |viminfo-file|. And Vim expects the terminal to use utf-8 too. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2355 setting 'encoding' to one of these values instead of utf-8 only has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2356 effect for encoding used for files when 'fileencoding' is empty.
448
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 446
diff changeset
2357
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 446
diff changeset
2358 When 'encoding' is set to a Unicode encoding, and 'fileencodings' was
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 446
diff changeset
2359 not set yet, the default for 'fileencodings' is changed.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2360
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2361 *'endofline'* *'eol'* *'noendofline'* *'noeol'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2362 'endofline' 'eol' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2363 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2364 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2365 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2366 is on, no <EOL> will be written for the last line in the file. This
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2367 option is automatically set when starting to edit a new file, unless
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2368 the file does not have an <EOL> for the last line in the file, in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2369 which case it is reset. Normally you don't have to set or reset this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2370 option. When 'binary' is off the value is not used when writing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2371 file. When 'binary' is on it is used to remember the presence of a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2372 <EOL> for the last line in the file, so that when you write the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2373 the situation from the original file can be kept. But you can change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2374 it if you want to.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2375
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2376 *'equalalways'* *'ea'* *'noequalalways'* *'noea'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2377 'equalalways' 'ea' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2378 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2379 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2380 When on, all the windows are automatically made the same size after
33
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2381 splitting or closing a window. This also happens the moment the
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2382 option is switched on. When off, splitting a window will reduce the
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2383 size of the current window and leave the other windows the same. When
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2384 closing a window the extra lines are given to the window next to it
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2385 (depending on 'splitbelow' and 'splitright').
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2386 When mixing vertically and horizontally split windows, a minimal size
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2387 is computed and some windows may be larger if there is room. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2388 'eadirection' option tells in which direction the size is affected.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2389 Changing the height of a window can be avoided by setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2390 'winfixheight'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2391
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2392 *'equalprg'* *'ep'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2393 'equalprg' 'ep' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2394 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2395 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2396 External program to use for "=" command. When this option is empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2397 the internal formatting functions are used ('lisp', 'cindent' or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2398 'indentexpr').
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2399 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2400 about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2401 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2402 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2403
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2404 *'errorbells'* *'eb'* *'noerrorbells'* *'noeb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2405 'errorbells' 'eb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2406 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2407 Ring the bell (beep or screen flash) for error messages. This only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2408 makes a difference for error messages, the bell will be used always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2409 for a lot of errors without a message (e.g., hitting <Esc> in Normal
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2410 mode). See 'visualbell' on how to make the bell behave like a beep,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2411 screen flash or do nothing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2412
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2413 *'errorfile'* *'ef'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2414 'errorfile' 'ef' string (Amiga default: "AztecC.Err",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2415 others: "errors.err")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2416 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2417 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2418 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2419 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2420 Name of the errorfile for the QuickFix mode (see |:cf|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2421 When the "-q" command-line argument is used, 'errorfile' is set to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2422 following argument. See |-q|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2423 NOT used for the ":make" command. See 'makeef' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2424 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2425 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2426 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2427 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2428
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2429 *'errorformat'* *'efm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2430 'errorformat' 'efm' string (default is very long)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2431 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2432 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2433 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2434 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2435 Scanf-like description of the format for the lines in the error file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2436 (see |errorformat|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2437
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2438 *'esckeys'* *'ek'* *'noesckeys'* *'noek'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2439 'esckeys' 'ek' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2440 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2441 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2442 Function keys that start with an <Esc> are recognized in Insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2443 mode. When this option is off, the cursor and function keys cannot be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2444 used in Insert mode if they start with an <Esc>. The advantage of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2445 this is that the single <Esc> is recognized immediately, instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2446 after one second. Instead of resetting this option, you might want to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2447 try changing the values for 'timeoutlen' and 'ttimeoutlen'. Note that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2448 when 'esckeys' is off, you can still map anything, but the cursor keys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2449 won't work by default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2450 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2451 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2452
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2453 *'eventignore'* *'ei'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2454 'eventignore' 'ei' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2455 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2456 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2457 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2458 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2459 A list of autocommand event names, which are to be ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2460 When set to "all", all autocommand events are ignored, autocommands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2461 will not be executed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2462 Otherwise this is a comma separated list of event names. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2463 :set ei=WinEnter,WinLeave
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2464 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2465 *'expandtab'* *'et'* *'noexpandtab'* *'noet'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2466 'expandtab' 'et' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2467 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2468 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2469 In Insert mode: Use the appropriate number of spaces to insert a
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2470 <Tab>. Spaces are used in indents with the '>' and '<' commands and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2471 when 'autoindent' is on. To insert a real tab when 'expandtab' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2472 on, use CTRL-V<Tab>. See also |:retab| and |ins-expandtab|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2473 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2474
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2475 *'exrc'* *'ex'* *'noexrc'* *'noex'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2476 'exrc' 'ex' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2477 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2478 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2479 Enables the reading of .vimrc, .exrc and .gvimrc in the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2480 directory. If you switch this option on you should also consider
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2481 setting the 'secure' option (see |initialization|). Using a local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2482 .exrc, .vimrc or .gvimrc is a potential security leak, use with care!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2483 also see |.vimrc| and |gui-init|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2484 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2485 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2486
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2487 *'fileencoding'* *'fenc'* *E213*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2488 'fileencoding' 'fenc' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2489 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2490 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2491 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2492 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2493 Sets the character encoding for the file of this buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2494 When 'fileencoding' is different from 'encoding', conversion will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2495 done when reading and writing the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2496 When 'fileencoding' is empty, the same value as 'encoding' will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2497 used (no conversion when reading or writing a file).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2498 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2499 'encoding' is "utf-8" conversion is most likely done in a way
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2500 that the reverse conversion results in the same text. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2501 'encoding' is not "utf-8" some characters may be lost!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2502 See 'encoding' for the possible values. Additionally, values may be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2503 specified that can be handled by the converter, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2504 |mbyte-conversion|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2505 When reading a file 'fileencoding' will be set from 'fileencodings'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2506 To read a file in a certain encoding it won't work by setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2507 'fileencoding', use the |++enc| argument.
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2508 For a new file the global value of 'fileencoding' is used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2509 Prepending "8bit-" and "2byte-" has no meaning here, they are ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2510 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2511 you can set it with uppercase values too. '_' characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2512 replaced with '-'. If a name is recognized from the list for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2513 'encoding', it is replaced by the standard name. For example
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2514 "ISO8859-2" becomes "iso-8859-2".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2515 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2516 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2517 If you do this in a modeline, you might want to set 'nomodified' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2518 avoid this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2519 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2520
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2521 *'fe'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2522 NOTE: Before version 6.0 this option specified the encoding for the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2523 whole of Vim, this was a mistake. Now use 'encoding' instead. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2524 old short name was 'fe', which is no longer used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2525
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2526 *'fileencodings'* *'fencs'*
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2527 'fileencodings' 'fencs' string (default: "ucs-bom",
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2528 "ucs-bom,utf-8,default,latin1" when
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2529 'encoding' is set to a Unicode value)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2530 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2531 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2532 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2533 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2534 This is a list of character encodings considered when starting to edit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2535 an existing file. When a file is read, Vim tries to use the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2536 mentioned character encoding. If an error is detected, the next one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2537 in the list is tried. When an encoding is found that works,
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2538 'fileencoding' is set to it. If all fail, 'fileencoding' is set to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2539 an empty string, which means the value of 'encoding' is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2540 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2541 'encoding' is "utf-8" (or one of the other Unicode variants)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2542 conversion is most likely done in a way that the reverse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2543 conversion results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not
596
e612bbdb670f updated for version 7.0169
vimboss
parents: 593
diff changeset
2544 "utf-8" some non-ASCII characters may be lost! You can use
e612bbdb670f updated for version 7.0169
vimboss
parents: 593
diff changeset
2545 the |++bad| argument to specify what is done with characters
e612bbdb670f updated for version 7.0169
vimboss
parents: 593
diff changeset
2546 that can't be converted.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2547 For an empty file or a file with only ASCII characters most encodings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2548 will work and the first entry of 'fileencodings' will be used (except
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2549 "ucs-bom", which requires the BOM to be present). If you prefer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2550 another encoding use an BufReadPost autocommand event to test if your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2551 preferred encoding is to be used. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2552 au BufReadPost * if search('\S', 'w') == 0 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2553 \ set fenc=iso-2022-jp | endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2554 < This sets 'fileencoding' to "iso-2022-jp" if the file does not contain
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2555 non-blank characters.
596
e612bbdb670f updated for version 7.0169
vimboss
parents: 593
diff changeset
2556 When the |++enc| argument is used then the value of 'fileencodings' is
e612bbdb670f updated for version 7.0169
vimboss
parents: 593
diff changeset
2557 not used.
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2558 Note that 'fileencodings' is not used for a new file, the global value
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2559 of 'fileencoding' is used instead. You can set it with: >
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2560 :setglobal fenc=iso-8859-2
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2561 < This means that a non-existing file may get a different encoding than
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2562 an empty file.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2563 The special value "ucs-bom" can be used to check for a Unicode BOM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2564 (Byte Order Mark) at the start of the file. It must not be preceded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2565 by "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding for this to work properly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2566 An entry for an 8-bit encoding (e.g., "latin1") should be the last,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2567 because Vim cannot detect an error, thus the encoding is always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2568 accepted.
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2569 The special value "default" can be used for the encoding from the
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2570 environment. This is the default value for 'encoding'. It is useful
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2571 when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and your environment uses a
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2572 non-latin1 encoding, such as Russian.
777
f664cc974a7a updated for version 7.0227
vimboss
parents: 772
diff changeset
2573 When 'encoding' is "utf-8" and a file contains an illegal byte
f664cc974a7a updated for version 7.0227
vimboss
parents: 772
diff changeset
2574 sequence it won't be recognized as UTF-8. You can use the |8g8|
f664cc974a7a updated for version 7.0227
vimboss
parents: 772
diff changeset
2575 command to find the illegal byte sequence.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2576 WRONG VALUES: WHAT'S WRONG:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2577 latin1,utf-8 "latin1" will always be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2578 utf-8,ucs-bom,latin1 BOM won't be recognized in an utf-8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2579 file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2580 cp1250,latin1 "cp1250" will always be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2581 If 'fileencodings' is empty, 'fileencoding' is not modified.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2582 See 'fileencoding' for the possible values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2583 Setting this option does not have an effect until the next time a file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2584 is read.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2585
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2586 *'fileformat'* *'ff'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2587 'fileformat' 'ff' string (MS-DOS, MS-Windows, OS/2 default: "dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2588 Unix default: "unix",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2589 Macintosh default: "mac")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2590 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2591 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2592 This gives the <EOL> of the current buffer, which is used for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2593 reading/writing the buffer from/to a file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2594 dos <CR> <NL>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2595 unix <NL>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2596 mac <CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2597 When "dos" is used, CTRL-Z at the end of a file is ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2598 See |file-formats| and |file-read|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2599 For the character encoding of the file see 'fileencoding'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2600 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformat' is ignored, file I/O
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2601 works like it was set to "unix'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2602 This option is set automatically when starting to edit a file and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2603 'fileformats' is not empty and 'binary' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2604 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2605 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2606 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2607 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to "dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2608 'textmode' is set, otherwise 'textmode' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2609
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2610 *'fileformats'* *'ffs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2611 'fileformats' 'ffs' string (default:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2612 Vim+Vi MS-DOS, MS-Windows OS/2: "dos,unix",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2613 Vim Unix: "unix,dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2614 Vim Mac: "mac,unix,dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2615 Vi Cygwin: "unix,dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2616 Vi others: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2617 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2618 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2619 This gives the end-of-line (<EOL>) formats that will be tried when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2620 starting to edit a new buffer and when reading a file into an existing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2621 buffer:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2622 - When empty, the format defined with 'fileformat' will be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2623 always. It is not set automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2624 - When set to one name, that format will be used whenever a new buffer
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2625 is opened. 'fileformat' is set accordingly for that buffer. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2626 'fileformats' name will be used when a file is read into an existing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2627 buffer, no matter what 'fileformat' for that buffer is set to.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2628 - When more than one name is present, separated by commas, automatic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2629 <EOL> detection will be done when reading a file. When starting to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2630 edit a file, a check is done for the <EOL>:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2631 1. If all lines end in <CR><NL>, and 'fileformats' includes "dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2632 'fileformat' is set to "dos".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2633 2. If a <NL> is found and 'fileformats' includes "unix", 'fileformat'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2634 is set to "unix". Note that when a <NL> is found without a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2635 preceding <CR>, "unix" is preferred over "dos".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2636 3. If 'fileformats' includes "mac", 'fileformat' is set to "mac".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2637 This means that "mac" is only chosen when "unix" is not present,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2638 or when no <NL> is found in the file, and when "dos" is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2639 present, or no <CR><NL> is present in the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2640 Also if "unix" was first chosen, but the first <CR> is before
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2641 the first <NL> and there appears to be more <CR>'s than <NL>'s in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2642 the file, then 'fileformat' is set to "mac".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2643 4. If 'fileformat' is still not set, the first name from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2644 'fileformats' is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2645 When reading a file into an existing buffer, the same is done, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2646 this happens like 'fileformat' has been set appropriately for that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2647 file only, the option is not changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2648 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformats' is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2649
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2650 For systems with a Dos-like <EOL> (<CR><NL>), when reading files that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2651 are ":source"ed and for vimrc files, automatic <EOL> detection may be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2652 done:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2653 - When 'fileformats' is empty, there is no automatic detection. Dos
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2654 format will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2655 - When 'fileformats' is set to one or more names, automatic detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2656 is done. This is based on the first <NL> in the file: If there is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2657 <CR> in front of it, Dos format is used, otherwise Unix format is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2658 used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2659 Also see |file-formats|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2660 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to an empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2661 string or one format (no comma is included), 'textauto' is reset,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2662 otherwise 'textauto' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2663 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2664 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2665
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2666 *'filetype'* *'ft'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2667 'filetype' 'ft' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2668 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2669 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2670 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2671 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2672 When this option is set, the FileType autocommand event is triggered.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2673 All autocommands that match with the value of this option will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2674 executed. Thus the value of 'filetype' is used in place of the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2675 name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2676 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current file type.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2677 This option is normally set when the file type is detected. To enable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2678 this use the ":filetype on" command. |:filetype|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2679 Setting this option to a different value is most useful in a modeline,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2680 for a file for which the file type is not automatically recognized.
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2681 Example, for in an IDL file:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2682 /* vim: set filetype=idl : */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2683 |FileType| |filetypes|
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2684 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2685 names. Example:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2686 /* vim: set filetype=c.doxygen : */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2687 This will use the "c" filetype first, then the "doxygen" filetype.
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2688 This works both for filetype plugins and for syntax files. More than
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2689 one dot may appear.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2690 Do not confuse this option with 'osfiletype', which is for the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2691 type that is actually stored with the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2692 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2693 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2694 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2695
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2696 *'fillchars'* *'fcs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2697 'fillchars' 'fcs' string (default "vert:|,fold:-")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2698 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2699 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2700 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2701 and |+folding| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2702 Characters to fill the statuslines and vertical separators.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2703 It is a comma separated list of items:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2704
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2705 item default Used for ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2706 stl:c ' ' or '^' statusline of the current window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2707 stlnc:c ' ' or '-' statusline of the non-current windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2708 vert:c '|' vertical separators |:vsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2709 fold:c '-' filling 'foldtext'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2710 diff:c '-' deleted lines of the 'diff' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2711
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2712 Any one that is omitted will fall back to the default. For "stl" and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2713 "stlnc" the space will be used when there is highlighting, '^' or '-'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2714 otherwise.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2715
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2716 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2717 :set fillchars=stl:^,stlnc:-,vert:\|,fold:-,diff:-
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2718 < This is similar to the default, except that these characters will also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2719 be used when there is highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2720
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
2721 for "stl" and "stlnc" only single-byte values are supported.
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
2722
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2723 The highlighting used for these items:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2724 item highlight group ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2725 stl:c StatusLine |hl-StatusLine|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2726 stlnc:c StatusLineNC |hl-StatusLineNC|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2727 vert:c VertSplit |hl-VertSplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2728 fold:c Folded |hl-Folded|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2729 diff:c DiffDelete |hl-DiffDelete|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2730
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2731 *'fkmap'* *'fk'* *'nofkmap'* *'nofk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2732 'fkmap' 'fk' boolean (default off) *E198*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2733 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2734 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2735 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2736 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2737 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Farsi character set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2738 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2739 toggle this option |i_CTRL-_|. See |farsi.txt|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2740
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2741 *'foldclose'* *'fcl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2742 'foldclose' 'fcl' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2743 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2744 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2745 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2746 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2747 When set to "all", a fold is closed when the cursor isn't in it and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2748 its level is higher than 'foldlevel'. Useful if you want folds to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2749 automatically close when moving out of them.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2750
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2751 *'foldcolumn'* *'fdc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2752 'foldcolumn' 'fdc' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2753 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2754 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2755 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2756 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2757 When non-zero, a column with the specified width is shown at the side
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2758 of the window which indicates open and closed folds. The maximum
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2759 value is 12.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2760 See |folding|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2761
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2762 *'foldenable'* *'fen'* *'nofoldenable'* *'nofen'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2763 'foldenable' 'fen' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2764 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2765 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2766 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2767 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2768 When off, all folds are open. This option can be used to quickly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2769 switch between showing all text unfolded and viewing the text with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2770 folds (including manually opened or closed folds). It can be toggled
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2771 with the |zi| command. The 'foldcolumn' will remain blank when
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2772 'foldenable' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2773 This option is set by commands that create a new fold or close a fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2774 See |folding|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2775
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2776 *'foldexpr'* *'fde'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2777 'foldexpr' 'fde' string (default: "0")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2778 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2779 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2780 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2781 or |+eval| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2782 The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
2783 for each line to obtain its fold level. See |fold-expr|.
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2784
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
2785 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
2786 |sandbox-option|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
2787
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
2788 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
2789 evaluating 'foldexpr' |textlock|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2790
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2791 *'foldignore'* *'fdi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2792 'foldignore' 'fdi' string (default: "#")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2793 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2794 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2795 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2796 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2797 Used only when 'foldmethod' is "indent". Lines starting with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2798 characters in 'foldignore' will get their fold level from surrounding
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2799 lines. White space is skipped before checking for this character.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2800 The default "#" works well for C programs. See |fold-indent|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2801
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2802 *'foldlevel'* *'fdl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2803 'foldlevel' 'fdl' number (default: 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2804 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2805 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2806 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2807 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2808 Sets the fold level: Folds with a higher level will be closed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2809 Setting this option to zero will close all folds. Higher numbers will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2810 close fewer folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2811 This option is set by commands like |zm|, |zM| and |zR|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2812 See |fold-foldlevel|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2813
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2814 *'foldlevelstart'* *'fdls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2815 'foldlevelstart' 'fdls' number (default: -1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2816 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2817 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2818 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2819 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2820 Sets 'foldlevel' when starting to edit another buffer in a window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2821 Useful to always start editing with all folds closed (value zero),
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2822 some folds closed (one) or no folds closed (99).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2823 This is done before reading any modeline, thus a setting in a modeline
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2824 overrules this option. Starting to edit a file for |diff-mode| also
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2825 ignores this option and closes all folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2826 It is also done before BufReadPre autocommands, to allow an autocmd to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2827 overrule the 'foldlevel' value for specific files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2828 When the value is negative, it is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2829
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2830 *'foldmarker'* *'fmr'* *E536*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2831 'foldmarker' 'fmr' string (default: "{{{,}}}")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2832 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2833 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2834 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2835 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2836 The start and end marker used when 'foldmethod' is "marker". There
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2837 must be one comma, which separates the start and end marker. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2838 marker is a literal string (a regular expression would be too slow).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2839 See |fold-marker|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2840
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2841 *'foldmethod'* *'fdm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2842 'foldmethod' 'fdm' string (default: "manual")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2843 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2844 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2845 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2846 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2847 The kind of folding used for the current window. Possible values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2848 |fold-manual| manual Folds are created manually.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2849 |fold-indent| indent Lines with equal indent form a fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2850 |fold-expr| expr 'foldexpr' gives the fold level of a line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2851 |fold-marker| marker Markers are used to specify folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2852 |fold-syntax| syntax Syntax highlighting items specify folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2853 |fold-diff| diff Fold text that is not changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2854
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2855 *'foldminlines'* *'fml'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2856 'foldminlines' 'fml' number (default: 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2857 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2858 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2859 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2860 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2861 Sets the minimum number of screen lines for a fold to be displayed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2862 closed. Also for manually closed folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2863 Note that this only has an effect of what is displayed. After using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2864 "zc" to close a fold, which is displayed open because it's smaller
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2865 than 'foldminlines', a following "zc" may close a containing fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2866
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2867 *'foldnestmax'* *'fdn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2868 'foldnestmax' 'fdn' number (default: 20)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2869 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2870 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2871 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2872 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2873 Sets the maximum nesting of folds for the "indent" and "syntax"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2874 methods. This avoids that too many folds will be created. Using more
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2875 than 20 doesn't work, because the internal limit is 20.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2876
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2877 *'foldopen'* *'fdo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2878 'foldopen' 'fdo' string (default: "block,hor,mark,percent,quickfix,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2879 search,tag,undo")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2880 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2881 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2882 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2883 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2884 Specifies for which type of commands folds will be opened, if the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2885 command moves the cursor into a closed fold. It is a comma separated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2886 list of items.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2887 item commands ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2888 all any
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2889 block "(", "{", "[[", "[{", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2890 hor horizontal movements: "l", "w", "fx", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2891 insert any command in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2892 jump far jumps: "G", "gg", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2893 mark jumping to a mark: "'m", CTRL-O, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2894 percent "%"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2895 quickfix ":cn", ":crew", ":make", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2896 search search for a pattern: "/", "n", "*", "gd", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2897 (not for a search pattern in a ":" command)
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
2898 Also for |[s| and |]s|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2899 tag jumping to a tag: ":ta", CTRL-T, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2900 undo undo or redo: "u" and CTRL-R
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2901 When the command is part of a mapping this option is not used. Add
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2902 the |zv| command to the mapping to get the same effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2903 When a movement command is used for an operator (e.g., "dl" or "y%")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2904 this option is not used. This means the operator will include the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2905 whole closed fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2906 Note that vertical movements are not here, because it would make it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2907 very difficult to move onto a closed fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2908 In insert mode the folds containing the cursor will always be open
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2909 when text is inserted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2910 To close folds you can re-apply 'foldlevel' with the |zx| command or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2911 set the 'foldclose' option to "all".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2912
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2913 *'foldtext'* *'fdt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2914 'foldtext' 'fdt' string (default: "foldtext()")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2915 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2916 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2917 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2918 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2919 An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2920 fold. See |fold-foldtext|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2921
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
2922 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
2923 |sandbox-option|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
2924
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
2925 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
2926 evaluating 'foldtext' |textlock|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
2927
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2928 *'formatoptions'* *'fo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2929 'formatoptions' 'fo' string (Vim default: "tcq", Vi default: "vt")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2930 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2931 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2932 This is a sequence of letters which describes how automatic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2933 formatting is to be done. See |fo-table|. When the 'paste' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2934 on, no formatting is done (like 'formatoptions' is empty). Commas can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2935 be inserted for readability.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2936 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2937 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2938 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2939 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2940
41
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2941 *'formatlistpat'* *'flp'*
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2942 'formatlistpat' 'flp' string (default: "^\s*\d\+[\]:.)}\t ]\s*")
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2943 local to buffer
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2944 {not in Vi}
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2945 A pattern that is used to recognize a list header. This is used for
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2946 the "n" flag in 'formatoptions'.
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2947 The pattern must match exactly the text that will be the indent for
140
8ecb0db93e9a updated for version 7.0045
vimboss
parents: 99
diff changeset
2948 the line below it. You can use |/\ze| to mark the end of the match
41
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2949 while still checking more characters. There must be a character
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2950 following the pattern, when it matches the whole line it is handled
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2951 like there is no match.
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2952 The default recognizes a number, followed by an optional punctuation
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2953 character and white space.
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
2954
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2955 *'formatprg'* *'fp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2956 'formatprg' 'fp' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2957 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2958 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2959 The name of an external program that will be used to format the lines
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2960 selected with the |gq| operator. The program must take the input on
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2961 stdin and produce the output on stdout. The Unix program "fmt" is
557
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
2962 such a program.
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2963 If the 'formatexpr' option is not empty it will be used instead.
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2964 Otherwise, if 'formatprg' option is an empty string, the internal
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2965 format function will be used |C-indenting|.
557
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
2966 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
2967 about including spaces and backslashes.
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2968 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2969 |sandbox-option|.
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2970
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2971 *'formatexpr'* *'fex'*
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2972 'formatexpr' 'fex' string (default "")
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2973 local to buffer
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2974 {not in Vi}
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2975 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2976 feature}
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2977 Expression which is evaluated to format a range of lines for the |gq|
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2978 operator. The |v:lnum| variable holds the first line to be formatted,
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2979 |v:count| the number of lines to be formatted.
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2980 When this option is empty 'formatprg' is used.
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2981 Example: >
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
2982 :set formatexpr=mylang#Format()
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2983 < This will invoke the mylang#Format() function in the
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2984 autoload/mylang.vim file in 'runtimepath'. |autoload|
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2985
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2986 The expression is also evaluated when 'textwidth' is set and adding
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2987 text beyond that limit. This happens under the same conditions as
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2988 when internal formatting is used. Make sure the cursor is kept in the
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2989 same spot relative to the text then! The |mode()| function will
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2990 return "i" or "R" in this situation. When the function returns
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2991 non-zero Vim will fall back to using the internal format mechanism.
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2992
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2993 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2994 |sandbox-option|.
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2995
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
2996 *'fsync'* *'fs'*
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2997 'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on)
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2998 global
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2999 {not in Vi}
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3000 When on, the library function fsync() will be called after writing a
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3001 file. This will flush a file to disk, ensuring that it is safely
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3002 written even on filesystems which do metadata-only journaling. This
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3003 will force the harddrive to spin up on Linux systems running in laptop
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3004 mode, so it may be undesirable in some situations. Be warned that
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3005 turning this off increases the chances of data loss after a crash. On
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3006 systems without an fsync() implementation, this variable is always
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3007 off.
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3008 Also see 'swapsync' for controlling fsync() on swap files.
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3009
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3010 *'gdefault'* *'gd'* *'nogdefault'* *'nogd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3011 'gdefault' 'gd' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3012 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3013 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3014 When on, the ":substitute" flag 'g' is default on. This means that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3015 all matches in a line are substituted instead of one. When a 'g' flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3016 is given to a ":substitute" command, this will toggle the substitution
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3017 of all or one match. See |complex-change|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3018
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3019 command 'gdefault' on 'gdefault' off ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3020 :s/// subst. all subst. one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3021 :s///g subst. one subst. all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3022 :s///gg subst. all subst. one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3023
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3024 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3025
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3026 *'grepformat'* *'gfm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3027 'grepformat' 'gfm' string (default "%f:%l%m,%f %l%m")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3028 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3029 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3030 Format to recognize for the ":grep" command output.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3031 This is a scanf-like string that uses the same format as the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3032 'errorformat' option: see |errorformat|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3033
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3034 *'grepprg'* *'gp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3035 'grepprg' 'gp' string (default "grep -n ",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3036 Unix: "grep -n $* /dev/null",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3037 Win32: "findstr /n" or "grep -n",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3038 VMS: "SEARCH/NUMBERS ")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3039 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3040 {not in Vi}
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
3041 Program to use for the |:grep| command. This option may contain '%'
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3042 and '#' characters, which are expanded like when used in a command-
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3043 line. The placeholder "$*" is allowed to specify where the arguments
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3044 will be included. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3045 |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3046 When your "grep" accepts the "-H" argument, use this to make ":grep"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3047 also work well with a single file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3048 :set grepprg=grep\ -nH
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
3049 < Special value: When 'grepprg' is set to "internal" the |:grep| command
657
b112ec5c73f0 updated for version 7.0193
vimboss
parents: 653
diff changeset
3050 works like |:vimgrep|, |:lgrep| like |:lvimgrep|, |:grepadd| like
b112ec5c73f0 updated for version 7.0193
vimboss
parents: 653
diff changeset
3051 |:vimgrepadd| and |:lgrepadd| like |:lvimgrepadd|.
41
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3052 See also the section |:make_makeprg|, since most of the comments there
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3053 apply equally to 'grepprg'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3054 For Win32, the default is "findstr /n" if "findstr.exe" can be found,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3055 otherwise it's "grep -n".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3056 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3057 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3058
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3059 *'guicursor'* *'gcr'* *E545* *E546* *E548* *E549*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3060 'guicursor' 'gcr' string (default "n-v-c:block-Cursor/lCursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3061 ve:ver35-Cursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3062 o:hor50-Cursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3063 i-ci:ver25-Cursor/lCursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3064 r-cr:hor20-Cursor/lCursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3065 sm:block-Cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3066 -blinkwait175-blinkoff150-blinkon175",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3067 for MS-DOS and Win32 console:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3068 "n-v-c:block,o:hor50,i-ci:hor15,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3069 r-cr:hor30,sm:block")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3070 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3071 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3072 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3073 for MS-DOS and Win32 console}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3074 This option tells Vim what the cursor should look like in different
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3075 modes. It fully works in the GUI. In an MSDOS or Win32 console, only
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3076 the height of the cursor can be changed. This can be done by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3077 specifying a block cursor, or a percentage for a vertical or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3078 horizontal cursor.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3079 For a console the 't_SI' and 't_EI' escape sequences are used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3080
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3081 The option is a comma separated list of parts. Each part consist of a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3082 mode-list and an argument-list:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3083 mode-list:argument-list,mode-list:argument-list,..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3084 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3085 n Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3086 v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3087 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3088 if not specified)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3089 o Operator-pending mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3090 i Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3091 r Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3092 c Command-line Normal (append) mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3093 ci Command-line Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3094 cr Command-line Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3095 sm showmatch in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3096 a all modes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3097 The argument-list is a dash separated list of these arguments:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3098 hor{N} horizontal bar, {N} percent of the character height
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3099 ver{N} vertical bar, {N} percent of the character width
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3100 block block cursor, fills the whole character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3101 [only one of the above three should be present]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3102 blinkwait{N} *cursor-blinking*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3103 blinkon{N}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3104 blinkoff{N}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3105 blink times for cursor: blinkwait is the delay before
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3106 the cursor starts blinking, blinkon is the time that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3107 the cursor is shown and blinkoff is the time that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3108 cursor is not shown. The times are in msec. When one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3109 of the numbers is zero, there is no blinking. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3110 default is: "blinkwait700-blinkon400-blinkoff250".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3111 These numbers are used for a missing entry. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3112 means that blinking is enabled by default. To switch
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3113 blinking off you can use "blinkon0". The cursor only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3114 blinks when Vim is waiting for input, not while
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3115 executing a command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3116 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3117 |xterm-blink|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3118 {group-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3119 a highlight group name, that sets the color and font
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3120 for the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3121 {group-name}/{group-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3122 Two highlight group names, the first is used when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3123 no language mappings are used, the other when they
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3124 are. |language-mapping|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3125
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3126 Examples of parts:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3127 n-c-v:block-nCursor in Normal, Command-line and Visual mode, use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3128 block cursor with colors from the "nCursor"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3129 highlight group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3130 i-ci:ver30-iCursor-blinkwait300-blinkon200-blinkoff150
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3131 In Insert and Command-line Insert mode, use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3132 30% vertical bar cursor with colors from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3133 "iCursor" highlight group. Blink a bit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3134 faster.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3135
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3136 The 'a' mode is different. It will set the given argument-list for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3137 all modes. It does not reset anything to defaults. This can be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3138 to do a common setting for all modes. For example, to switch off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3139 blinking: "a:blinkon0"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3140
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3141 Examples of cursor highlighting: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3142 :highlight Cursor gui=reverse guifg=NONE guibg=NONE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3143 :highlight Cursor gui=NONE guifg=bg guibg=fg
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3144 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3145 *'guifont'* *'gfn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3146 *E235* *E596* *E610* *E611*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3147 'guifont' 'gfn' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3148 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3149 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3150 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3151 This is a list of fonts which will be used for the GUI version of Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3152 In its simplest form the value is just one font name. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3153 the font cannot be found you will get an error message. To try other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3154 font names a list can be specified, font names separated with commas.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3155 The first valid font is used.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3156
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3157 On systems where 'guifontset' is supported (X11) and 'guifontset' is
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3158 not empty, then 'guifont' is not used.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3159
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3160 Spaces after a comma are ignored. To include a comma in a font name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3161 precede it with a backslash. Setting an option requires an extra
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3162 backslash before a space and a backslash. See also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3163 |option-backslash|. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3164 :set guifont=Screen15,\ 7x13,font\\,with\\,commas
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3165 < will make Vim try to use the font "Screen15" first, and if it fails it
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3166 will try to use "7x13" and then "font,with,commas" instead.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3167
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3168 If none of the fonts can be loaded, Vim will keep the current setting.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3169 If an empty font list is given, Vim will try using other resource
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3170 settings (for X, it will use the Vim.font resource), and finally it
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3171 will try some builtin default which should always be there ("7x13" in
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3172 the case of X). The font names given should be "normal" fonts. Vim
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3173 will try to find the related bold and italic fonts.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3174
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3175 For Win32, GTK, Mac OS and Photon: >
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3176 :set guifont=*
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3177 < will bring up a font requester, where you can pick the font you want.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3178
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3179 The font name depends on the GUI used. See |setting-guifont| for a
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3180 way to set 'guifont' for various systems.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3181
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3182 For the GTK+ 2 GUI the font name looks like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3183 :set guifont=Andale\ Mono\ 11
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3184 < That's all. XLFDs are no longer accepted.
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3185
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3186 For Mac OSX you can use something like this: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3187 :set guifont=Monaco:h10
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3188 < *E236*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3189 Note that the fonts must be mono-spaced (all characters have the same
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3190 width). An exception is GTK 2: all fonts are accepted, but
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3191 mono-spaced fonts look best.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3192
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3193 To preview a font on X11, you might be able to use the "xfontsel"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3194 program. The "xlsfonts" program gives a list of all available fonts.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3195
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3196 For the Win32 GUI *E244* *E245*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3197 - takes these options in the font name:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3198 hXX - height is XX (points, can be floating-point)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3199 wXX - width is XX (points, can be floating-point)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3200 b - bold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3201 i - italic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3202 u - underline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3203 s - strikeout
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
3204 cXX - character set XX. Valid charsets are: ANSI, ARABIC,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3205 BALTIC, CHINESEBIG5, DEFAULT, EASTEUROPE, GB2312, GREEK,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3206 HANGEUL, HEBREW, JOHAB, MAC, OEM, RUSSIAN, SHIFTJIS,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3207 SYMBOL, THAI, TURKISH, VIETNAMESE ANSI and BALTIC.
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 20
diff changeset
3208 Normally you would use "cDEFAULT".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3209
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3210 Use a ':' to separate the options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3211 - A '_' can be used in the place of a space, so you don't need to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3212 backslashes to escape the spaces.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3213 - Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3214 :set guifont=courier_new:h12:w5:b:cRUSSIAN
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3215 :set guifont=Andale_Mono:h7.5:w4.5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3216 < See also |font-sizes|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3217
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3218 *'guifontset'* *'gfs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3219 *E250* *E252* *E234* *E597* *E598*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3220 'guifontset' 'gfs' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3221 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3222 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3223 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3224 with the |+xfontset| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3225 {not available in the GTK+ 2 GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3226 When not empty, specifies two (or more) fonts to be used. The first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3227 one for normal English, the second one for your special language. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3228 |xfontset|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3229 Setting this option also means that all font names will be handled as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3230 a fontset name. Also the ones used for the "font" argument of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3231 |:highlight| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3232 The fonts must match with the current locale. If fonts for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3233 character sets that the current locale uses are not included, setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3234 'guifontset' will fail.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3235 Note the difference between 'guifont' and 'guifontset': In 'guifont'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3236 the comma-separated names are alternative names, one of which will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3237 used. In 'guifontset' the whole string is one fontset name,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3238 including the commas. It is not possible to specify alternative
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3239 fontset names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3240 This example works on many X11 systems: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3241 :set guifontset=-*-*-medium-r-normal--16-*-*-*-c-*-*-*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3242 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3243 *'guifontwide'* *'gfw'* *E231* *E533* *E534*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3244 'guifontwide' 'gfw' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3245 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3246 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3247 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3248 When not empty, specifies a comma-separated list of fonts to be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3249 for double-width characters. The first font that can be loaded is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3250 used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3251 Note: The size of these fonts must be exactly twice as wide as the one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3252 specified with 'guifont' and the same height.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3253
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3254 All GUI versions but GTK+ 2:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3255
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3256 'guifontwide' is only used when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3257 'guifontset' is empty or invalid.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3258 When 'guifont' is set and a valid font is found in it and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3259 'guifontwide' is empty Vim will attempt to find a matching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3260 double-width font and set 'guifontwide' to it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3261
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3262 GTK+ 2 GUI only: *guifontwide_gtk2*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3263
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3264 If set and valid, 'guifontwide' is always used for double width
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3265 characters, even if 'encoding' is not set to "utf-8".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3266 Vim does not attempt to find an appropriate value for 'guifontwide'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3267 automatically. If 'guifontwide' is empty Pango/Xft will choose the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3268 font for characters not available in 'guifont'. Thus you do not need
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3269 to set 'guifontwide' at all unless you want to override the choice
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3270 made by Pango/Xft.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3271
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3272 *'guiheadroom'* *'ghr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3273 'guiheadroom' 'ghr' number (default 50)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3274 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3275 {not in Vi} {only for GTK and X11 GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3276 The number of pixels subtracted from the screen height when fitting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3277 the GUI window on the screen. Set this before the GUI is started,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3278 e.g., in your |gvimrc| file. When zero, the whole screen height will
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3279 be used by the window. When positive, the specified number of pixel
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3280 lines will be left for window decorations and other items on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3281 screen. Set it to a negative value to allow windows taller than the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3282 screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3283
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3284 *'guioptions'* *'go'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3285 'guioptions' 'go' string (default "gmrLtT" (MS-Windows),
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
3286 "agimrLtT" (GTK, Motif and Athena))
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3287 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3288 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3289 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3290 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim. It is a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3291 sequence of letters which describes what components and options of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3292 GUI should be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3293 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3294 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3295
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3296 Valid letters are as follows:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3297 *guioptions_a*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3298 'a' Autoselect: If present, then whenever VISUAL mode is started,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3299 or the Visual area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3300 the windowing system's global selection. This means that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3301 Visually highlighted text is available for pasting into other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3302 applications as well as into Vim itself. When the Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3303 ends, possibly due to an operation on the text, or when an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3304 application wants to paste the selection, the highlighted text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3305 is automatically yanked into the "* selection register.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3306 Thus the selection is still available for pasting into other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3307 applications after the VISUAL mode has ended.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3308 If not present, then Vim won't become the owner of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3309 windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3310 by a yank or delete operation for the "* register.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3311 The same applies to the modeless selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3312
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3313 'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3314 applies to the modeless selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3315
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3316 'guioptions' autoselect Visual autoselect modeless ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3317 "" - -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3318 "a" yes yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3319 "A" - yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3320 "aA" yes yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3321
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3322 'c' Use console dialogs instead of popup dialogs for simple
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3323 choices.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3324
697
f08390485cd3 updated for version 7.0210
vimboss
parents: 694
diff changeset
3325 'e' Add tab pages when indicated with 'showtabline'.
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3326 'guitablabel' can be used to change the text in the labels.
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3327 When 'e' is missing a non-GUI tab pages line may be used.
714
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
3328 The GUI tabs are only supported on some systens, currently
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
3329 only for GTK.
685
d7e33248b9c8 updated for version 7.0206
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
3330
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3331 'f' Foreground: Don't use fork() to detach the GUI from the shell
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3332 where it was started. Use this for programs that wait for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3333 editor to finish (e.g., an e-mail program). Alternatively you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3334 can use "gvim -f" or ":gui -f" to start the GUI in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3335 foreground. |gui-fork|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3336 Note: Set this option in the vimrc file. The forking may have
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3337 happened already when the |gvimrc| file is read.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3338
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3339 'i' Use a Vim icon. For GTK with KDE it is used in the left-upper
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3340 corner of the window. It's black&white on non-GTK, because of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3341 limitations of X11. For a color icon, see |X11-icon|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3342
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3343 'm' Menu bar is present.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3344 'M' The system menu "$VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim" is not sourced. Note
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3345 that this flag must be added in the .vimrc file, before
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3346 switching on syntax or filetype recognition (when the |gvimrc|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3347 file is sourced the system menu has already been loaded; the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3348 ":syntax on" and ":filetype on" commands load the menu too).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3349 'g' Grey menu items: Make menu items that are not active grey. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3350 'g' is not included inactive menu items are not shown at all.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3351 Exception: Athena will always use grey menu items.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3352
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3353 't' Include tearoff menu items. Currently only works for Win32,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3354 GTK+, and Motif 1.2 GUI.
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
3355 'T' Include Toolbar. Currently only in Win32, GTK+, Motif, Photon
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
3356 and Athena GUIs.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3357
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3358 'r' Right-hand scrollbar is always present.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3359 'R' Right-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3360 split window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3361 'l' Left-hand scrollbar is always present.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3362 'L' Left-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3363 split window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3364 'b' Bottom (horizontal) scrollbar is present. Its size depends on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3365 the longest visible line, or on the cursor line if the 'h'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3366 flag is included. |gui-horiz-scroll|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3367 'h' Limit horizontal scrollbar size to the length of the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3368 line. Reduces computations. |gui-horiz-scroll|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3369
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3370 And yes, you may even have scrollbars on the left AND the right if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3371 you really want to :-). See |gui-scrollbars| for more information.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3372
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3373 'v' Use a vertical button layout for dialogs. When not included,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3374 a horizontal layout is preferred, but when it doesn't fit a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3375 vertical layout is used anyway.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3376 'p' Use Pointer callbacks for X11 GUI. This is required for some
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3377 window managers. If the cursor is not blinking or hollow at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3378 the right moment, try adding this flag. This must be done
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3379 before starting the GUI. Set it in your |gvimrc|. Adding or
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3380 removing it after the GUI has started has no effect.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3381 'F' Add a footer. Only for Motif. See |gui-footer|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3382
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3383 *'guipty'* *'noguipty'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3384 'guipty' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3385 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3386 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3387 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3388 Only in the GUI: If on, an attempt is made to open a pseudo-tty for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3389 I/O to/from shell commands. See |gui-pty|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3390
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3391 *'guitablabel'* *'gtl'*
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3392 'guitablabel' 'gtl' string (default empty)
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3393 global
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3394 {not in Vi}
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
3395 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
3396 with the +windows feature}
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3397 When nonempty describes the text to use in a label of the GUI tab
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
3398 pages line. When empty Vim will use a default label. See
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3399 |setting-guitablabel| for more info.
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3400
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
3401 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
3402
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3403 Only used when the GUI tab pages line is displayed. 'e' must be
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3404 present in 'guioptions'. For the non-GUI tab pages line 'tabline' is
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3405 used.
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3406
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3407 *'helpfile'* *'hf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3408 'helpfile' 'hf' string (default (MSDOS) "$VIMRUNTIME\doc\help.txt"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3409 (others) "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3410 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3411 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3412 Name of the main help file. All distributed help files should be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3413 placed together in one directory. Additionally, all "doc" directories
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3414 in 'runtimepath' will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3415 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. For example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3416 "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt". If $VIMRUNTIME is not set, $VIM is also
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3417 tried. Also see |$VIMRUNTIME| and |option-backslash| about including
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3418 spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3419 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3420 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3421
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3422 *'helpheight'* *'hh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3423 'helpheight' 'hh' number (default 20)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3424 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3425 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3426 {not available when compiled without the +windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3427 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3428 Minimal initial height of the help window when it is opened with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3429 ":help" command. The initial height of the help window is half of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3430 current window, or (when the 'ea' option is on) the same as other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3431 windows. When the height is less than 'helpheight', the height is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3432 set to 'helpheight'. Set to zero to disable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3433
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3434 *'helplang'* *'hlg'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3435 'helplang' 'hlg' string (default: messages language or empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3436 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3437 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3438 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3439 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3440 Comma separated list of languages. Vim will use the first language
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3441 for which the desired help can be found. The English help will always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3442 be used as a last resort. You can add "en" to prefer English over
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3443 another language, but that will only find tags that exist in that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3444 language and not in the English help.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3445 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3446 :set helplang=de,it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3447 < This will first search German, then Italian and finally English help
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3448 files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3449 When using |CTRL-]| and ":help!" in a non-English help file Vim will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3450 try to find the tag in the current language before using this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3451 See |help-translated|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3452
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3453 *'hidden'* *'hid'* *'nohidden'* *'nohid'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3454 'hidden' 'hid' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3455 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3456 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3457 When off a buffer is unloaded when it is |abandon|ed. When on a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3458 buffer becomes hidden when it is |abandon|ed. If the buffer is still
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3459 displayed in another window, it does not become hidden, of course.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3460 The commands that move through the buffer list sometimes make a buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3461 hidden although the 'hidden' option is off: When the buffer is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3462 modified, 'autowrite' is off or writing is not possible, and the '!'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3463 flag was used. See also |windows.txt|.
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
3464 To only make one buffer hidden use the 'bufhidden' option.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3465 This option is set for one command with ":hide {command}" |:hide|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3466 WARNING: It's easy to forget that you have changes in hidden buffers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3467 Think twice when using ":q!" or ":qa!".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3468
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3469 *'highlight'* *'hl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3470 'highlight' 'hl' string (default (as a single string):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3471 "8:SpecialKey,@:NonText,d:Directory,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3472 e:ErrorMsg,i:IncSearch,l:Search,m:MoreMsg,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3473 M:ModeMsg,n:LineNr,r:Question,
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3474 s:StatusLine,S:StatusLineNC,c:VertSplit,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3475 t:Title,v:Visual,w:WarningMsg,W:WildMenu,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3476 f:Folded,F:FoldColumn,A:DiffAdd,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3477 C:DiffChange,D:DiffDelete,T:DiffText,
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3478 >:SignColumn,B:SpellBad,P:SpellCap,
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3479 R:SpellRare,L:SpellLocal,
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3480 +:Pmenu,=:PmenuSel,
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3481 x:PmenuSbar,X:PmenuThumb")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3482 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3483 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3484 This option can be used to set highlighting mode for various
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3485 occasions. It is a comma separated list of character pairs. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3486 first character in a pair gives the occasion, the second the mode to
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3487 use for that occasion. The occasions are:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3488 |hl-SpecialKey| 8 Meta and special keys listed with ":map"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3489 |hl-NonText| @ '~' and '@' at the end of the window and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3490 characters from 'showbreak'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3491 |hl-Directory| d directories in CTRL-D listing and other special
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3492 things in listings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3493 |hl-ErrorMsg| e error messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3494 h (obsolete, ignored)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3495 |hl-IncSearch| i 'incsearch' highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3496 |hl-Search| l last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3497 |hl-MoreMsg| m |more-prompt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3498 |hl-ModeMsg| M Mode (e.g., "-- INSERT --")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3499 |hl-LineNr| n line number for ":number" and ":#" commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3500 |hl-Question| r |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3501 |hl-StatusLine| s status line of current window |status-line|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3502 |hl-StatusLineNC| S status lines of not-current windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3503 |hl-Title| t Titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3504 |hl-VertSplit| c column used to separate vertically split windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3505 |hl-Visual| v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3506 |hl-VisualNOS| V Visual mode when Vim does is "Not Owning the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3507 Selection" Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3508 |xterm-clipboard|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3509 |hl-WarningMsg| w warning messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3510 |hl-WildMenu| W wildcard matches displayed for 'wildmenu'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3511 |hl-Folded| f line used for closed folds
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3512 |hl-FoldColumn| F 'foldcolumn'
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3513 |hl-DiffAdd| A added line in diff mode
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3514 |hl-DiffChange| C changed line in diff mode
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3515 |hl-DiffDelete| D deleted line in diff mode
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3516 |hl-DiffText| T inserted text in diff mode
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3517 |hl-SignColumn| > column used for |signs|
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
3518 |hl-SpellBad| B misspelled word |spell|
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3519 |hl-SpellCap| P word that should start with capital|spell|
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
3520 |hl-SpellRare| R rare word |spell|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
3521 |hl-SpellLocal| L word from other region |spell|
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3522 |hl-Pmenu| + popup menu normal line
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3523 |hl-PmenuSel| = popup menu normal line
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3524 |hl-PmenuSbar| x popup menu scrollbar
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3525 |hl-PmenuThumb| X popup menu scrollbar thumb
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3526
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3527 The display modes are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3528 r reverse (termcap entry "mr" and "me")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3529 i italic (termcap entry "ZH" and "ZR")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3530 b bold (termcap entry "md" and "me")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3531 s standout (termcap entry "so" and "se")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3532 u underline (termcap entry "us" and "ue")
205
d292c40ca788 updated for version 7.0060
vimboss
parents: 199
diff changeset
3533 c undercurl (termcap entry "Cs" and "Ce")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3534 n no highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3535 - no highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3536 : use a highlight group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3537 The default is used for occasions that are not included.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3538 If you want to change what the display modes do, see |dos-colors|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3539 for an example.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3540 When using the ':' display mode, this must be followed by the name of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3541 a highlight group. A highlight group can be used to define any type
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3542 of highlighting, including using color. See |:highlight| on how to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3543 define one. The default uses a different group for each occasion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3544 See |highlight-default| for the default highlight groups.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3545
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3546 *'hlsearch'* *'hls'* *'nohlsearch'* *'nohls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3547 'hlsearch' 'hls' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3548 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3549 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3550 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3551 |+extra_search| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3552 When there is a previous search pattern, highlight all its matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3553 The type of highlighting used can be set with the 'l' occasion in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3554 'highlight' option. This uses the "Search" highlight group by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3555 default. Note that only the matching text is highlighted, any offsets
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3556 are not applied.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3557 See also: 'incsearch' and |:match|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3558 When you get bored looking at the highlighted matches, you can turn it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3559 off with |:nohlsearch|. As soon as you use a search command, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3560 highlighting comes back.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3561 When the search pattern can match an end-of-line, Vim will try to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3562 highlight all of the matched text. However, this depends on where the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3563 search starts. This will be the first line in the window or the first
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3564 line below a closed fold. A match in a previous line which is not
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3565 drawn may not continue in a newly drawn line.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3566 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3567
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3568 *'history'* *'hi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3569 'history' 'hi' number (Vim default: 20, Vi default: 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3570 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3571 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3572 A history of ":" commands, and a history of previous search patterns
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3573 are remembered. This option decides how many entries may be stored in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3574 each of these histories (see |cmdline-editing|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3575 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3576 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3577
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3578 *'hkmap'* *'hk'* *'nohkmap'* *'nohk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3579 'hkmap' 'hk' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3580 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3581 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3582 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3583 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3584 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Hebrew character set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3585 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3586 toggle this option. See |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3587 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3588
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3589 *'hkmapp'* *'hkp'* *'nohkmapp'* *'nohkp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3590 'hkmapp' 'hkp' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3591 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3592 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3593 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3594 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3595 When on, phonetic keyboard mapping is used. 'hkmap' must also be on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3596 This is useful if you have a non-Hebrew keyboard.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3597 See |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3598 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3599
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3600 *'icon'* *'noicon'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3601 'icon' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3602 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3603 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3604 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3605 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3606 When on, the icon text of the window will be set to the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3607 'iconstring' (if it is not empty), or to the name of the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3608 currently being edited. Only the last part of the name is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3609 Overridden by the 'iconstring' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3610 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icons (currently
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3611 only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option - these are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3612 Unix xterm and iris-ansi by default, where 't_IS' is taken from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3613 builtin termcap).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3614 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
3615 restored if possible |X11|. See |X11-icon| for changing the icon on
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3616 X11.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3617
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3618 *'iconstring'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3619 'iconstring' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3620 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3621 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3622 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3623 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3624 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the icon text of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3625 the window. This happens only when the 'icon' option is on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3626 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icon text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3627 (currently only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3628 Does not work for MS Windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3629 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3630 restored if possible |X11|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3631 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3632 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. See
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3633 'titlestring' for example settings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3634 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3635
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3636 *'ignorecase'* *'ic'* *'noignorecase'* *'noic'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3637 'ignorecase' 'ic' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3638 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3639 Ignore case in search patterns. Also used when searching in the tags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3640 file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3641 Also see 'smartcase'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3642 Can be overruled by using "\c" or "\C" in the pattern, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3643 |/ignorecase|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3644
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3645 *'imactivatekey'* *'imak'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3646 'imactivatekey' 'imak' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3647 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3648 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3649 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3650 |+GUI_GTK|}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3651 Specifies the key that your Input Method in X-Windows uses for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3652 activation. When this is specified correctly, vim can fully control
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3653 IM with 'imcmdline', 'iminsert' and 'imsearch'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3654 You can't use this option to change the activation key, the option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3655 tells Vim what the key is.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3656 Format:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3657 [MODIFIER_FLAG-]KEY_STRING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3658
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3659 These characters can be used for MODIFIER_FLAG (case is ignored):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3660 S Shift key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3661 L Lock key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3662 C Control key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3663 1 Mod1 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3664 2 Mod2 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3665 3 Mod3 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3666 4 Mod4 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3667 5 Mod5 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3668 Combinations are allowed, for example "S-C-space" or "SC-space" are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3669 both shift+ctrl+space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3670 See <X11/keysymdef.h> and XStringToKeysym for KEY_STRING.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3671
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3672 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3673 :set imactivatekey=S-space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3674 < "S-space" means shift+space. This is the activation key for kinput2 +
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3675 canna (Japanese), and ami (Korean).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3676
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3677 *'imcmdline'* *'imc'* *'noimcmdline'* *'noimc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3678 'imcmdline' 'imc' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3679 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3680 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3681 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3682 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3683 When set the Input Method is always on when starting to edit a command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3684 line, unless entering a search pattern (see 'imsearch' for that).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3685 Setting this option is useful when your input method allows entering
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3686 English characters directly, e.g., when it's used to type accented
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3687 characters with dead keys.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3688
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3689 *'imdisable'* *'imd'* *'nodisable'* *'noimd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3690 'imdisable' 'imd' boolean (default off, on for some systems (SGI))
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3691 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3692 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3693 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3694 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3695 When set the Input Method is never used. This is useful to disable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3696 the IM when it doesn't work properly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3697 Currently this option is on by default for SGI/IRIX machines. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3698 may change in later releases.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3699
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3700 *'iminsert'* *'imi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3701 'iminsert' 'imi' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3702 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3703 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3704 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3705 Insert mode. Valid values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3706 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3707 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3708 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3709 2 is available only when compiled with the |+multi_byte_ime|, |+xim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3710 or |global-ime|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3711 To always reset the option to zero when leaving Insert mode with <Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3712 this can be used: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3713 :inoremap <ESC> <ESC>:set iminsert=0<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3714 < This makes :lmap and IM turn off automatically when leaving Insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3715 mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3716 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3717 |i_CTRL-^|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3718 The value is set to 1 when setting 'keymap' to a valid keymap name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3719 It is also used for the argument of commands like "r" and "f".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3720 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3721 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3722
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3723 *'imsearch'* *'ims'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3724 'imsearch' 'ims' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3725 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3726 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3727 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3728 entering a search pattern. Valid values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3729 -1 the value of 'iminsert' is used, makes it look like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3730 'iminsert' is also used when typing a search pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3731 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3732 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3733 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3734 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Command-line mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3735 |c_CTRL-^|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3736 The value is set to 1 when it is not -1 and setting the 'keymap'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3737 option to a valid keymap name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3738 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3739 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3740
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3741 *'include'* *'inc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3742 'include' 'inc' string (default "^\s*#\s*include")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3743 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3744 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3745 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3746 |+find_in_path| feature}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3747 Pattern to be used to find an include command. It is a search
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3748 pattern, just like for the "/" command (See |pattern|). The default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3749 value is for C programs. This option is used for the commands "[i",
532
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
3750 "]I", "[d", etc.
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
3751 Normally the 'isfname' option is used to recognize the file name that
534
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
3752 comes after the matched pattern. But if "\zs" appears in the pattern
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
3753 then the text matched from "\zs" to the end, or until "\ze" if it
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
3754 appears, is used as the file name. Use this to include characters
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
3755 that are not in 'isfname', such as a space. You can then use
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
3756 'includeexpr' to process the matched text.
532
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
3757 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3758
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3759 *'includeexpr'* *'inex'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3760 'includeexpr' 'inex' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3761 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3762 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3763 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3764 |+find_in_path| or |+eval| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3765 Expression to be used to transform the string found with the 'include'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3766 option to a file name. Mostly useful to change "." to "/" for Java: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3767 :set includeexpr=substitute(v:fname,'\\.','/','g')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3768 < The "v:fname" variable will be set to the file name that was detected.
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3769
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3770 Also used for the |gf| command if an unmodified file name can't be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3771 found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3772 Also used for |<cfile>|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3773
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3774 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3775 |sandbox-option|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3776
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3777 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3778 evaluating 'includeexpr' |textlock|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3779
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3780 *'incsearch'* *'is'* *'noincsearch'* *'nois'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3781 'incsearch' 'is' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3782 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3783 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3784 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3785 |+extra_search| feature}
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3786 While typing a search command, show where the pattern, as it was typed
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3787 so far, matches. The matched string is highlighted. If the pattern
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3788 is invalid or not found, nothing is shown. The screen will be updated
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3789 often, this is only useful on fast terminals.
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3790 Note that the match will be shown, but the cursor will return to its
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3791 original position when no match is found and when pressing <Esc>. You
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3792 still need to finish the search command with <Enter> to move the
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3793 cursor to the match.
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3794 The highlighting can be set with the 'i' flag in 'highlight'.
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
3795 See also: 'hlsearch'.
772
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
3796 CTRL-L can be used to add one character from after the current match
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
3797 to the command line.
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
3798 CTRL-R CTRL-W can be used to add the word at the end of the current
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
3799 match, excluding the characters that were already typed.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3800 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3801
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3802 *'indentexpr'* *'inde'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3803 'indentexpr' 'inde' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3804 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3805 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3806 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3807 or |+eval| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3808 Expression which is evaluated to obtain the proper indent for a line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3809 It is used when a new line is created, for the |=| operator and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3810 in Insert mode as specified with the 'indentkeys' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3811 When this option is not empty, it overrules the 'cindent' and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3812 'smartindent' indenting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3813 When 'paste' is set this option is not used for indenting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3814 The expression is evaluated with |v:lnum| set to the line number for
534
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
3815 which the indent is to be computed. The cursor is also in this line
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3816 when the expression is evaluated (but it may be moved around).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3817 The expression must return the number of spaces worth of indent. It
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3818 can return "-1" to keep the current indent (this means 'autoindent' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3819 used for the indent).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3820 Functions useful for computing the indent are |indent()|, |cindent()|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3821 and |lispindent()|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3822 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! It must
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3823 not change the text, jump to another window, etc. Afterwards the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3824 cursor position is always restored, thus the cursor may be moved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3825 Normally this option would be set to call a function: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3826 :set indentexpr=GetMyIndent()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3827 < Error messages will be suppressed, unless the 'debug' option contains
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3828 "msg".
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3829 See |indent-expression|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3830 NOTE: This option is made empty when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3831
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3832 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3833 |sandbox-option|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3834
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3835 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3836 evaluating 'indentexpr' |textlock|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3837
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3838
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3839 *'indentkeys'* *'indk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3840 'indentkeys' 'indk' string (default "0{,0},:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3841 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3842 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3843 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3844 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3845 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3846 the current line. Only happens if 'indentexpr' isn't empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3847 The format is identical to 'cinkeys', see |indentkeys-format|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3848 See |C-indenting| and |indent-expression|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3849
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3850 *'infercase'* *'inf'* *'noinfercase'* *'noinf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3851 'infercase' 'inf' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3852 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3853 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3854 When doing keyword completion in insert mode |ins-completion|, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3855 'ignorecase' is also on, the case of the match is adjusted. If the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3856 typed text contains a lowercase letter where the match has an upper
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3857 case letter, the completed part is made lowercase. If the typed text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3858 has no lowercase letters and the match has a lowercase letter where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3859 the typed text has an uppercase letter, and there is a letter before
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3860 it, the completed part is made uppercase.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3861
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3862 *'insertmode'* *'im'* *'noinsertmode'* *'noim'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3863 'insertmode' 'im' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3864 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3865 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3866 Makes Vim work in a way that Insert mode is the default mode. Useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3867 if you want to use Vim as a modeless editor. Used for |evim|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3868 These Insert mode commands will be useful:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3869 - Use the cursor keys to move around.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3870 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command |i_CTRL-O|). When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3871 this is a mapping, it is executed as if 'insertmode' was off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3872 Normal mode remains active until the mapping is finished.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3873 - Use CTRL-L to execute a number of Normal mode commands, then use
477
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 464
diff changeset
3874 <Esc> to get back to Insert mode. Note that CTRL-L moves the cursor
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 464
diff changeset
3875 left, like <Esc> does when 'insertmode' isn't set. |i_CTRL-L|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3876
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3877 These items change when 'insertmode' is set:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3878 - when starting to edit of a file, Vim goes to Insert mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3879 - <Esc> in Insert mode is a no-op and beeps.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3880 - <Esc> in Normal mode makes Vim go to Insert mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3881 - CTRL-L in Insert mode is a command, it is not inserted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3882 - CTRL-Z in Insert mode suspends Vim, see |CTRL-Z|. *i_CTRL-Z*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3883 However, when <Esc> is used inside a mapping, it behaves like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3884 'insertmode' was not set. This was done to be able to use the same
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3885 mappings with 'insertmode' set or not set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3886 When executing commands with |:normal| 'insertmode' is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3887
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3888 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3889
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3890 *'isfname'* *'isf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3891 'isfname' 'isf' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3892 "@,48-57,/,\,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,{,},[,],:,@-@,!,~,="
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3893 for AMIGA: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,$,:"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3894 for VMS: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,<,>,[,],:,;,~"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3895 for OS/390: "@,240-249,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,="
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3896 otherwise: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3897 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3898 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3899 The characters specified by this option are included in file names and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3900 path names. Filenames are used for commands like "gf", "[i" and in
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3901 the tags file. It is also used for "\f" in a |pattern|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3902 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3903 characters up to 255 are specified with this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3904 For UTF-8 the characters 0xa0 to 0xff are included as well.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3905
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3906 Note that on systems using a backslash as path separator, Vim tries to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3907 do its best to make it work as you would expect. That is a bit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3908 tricky, since Vi originally used the backslash to escape special
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3909 characters. Vim will not remove a backslash in front of a normal file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3910 name character on these systems, but it will on Unix and alikes. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3911 '&' and '^' are not included by default, because these are special for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3912 cmd.exe.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3913
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3914 The format of this option is a list of parts, separated with commas.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3915 Each part can be a single character number or a range. A range is two
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3916 character numbers with '-' in between. A character number can be a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3917 decimal number between 0 and 255 or the ASCII character itself (does
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3918 not work for digits). Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3919 "_,-,128-140,#-43" (include '_' and '-' and the range
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3920 128 to 140 and '#' to 43)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3921 If a part starts with '^', the following character number or range
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3922 will be excluded from the option. The option is interpreted from left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3923 to right. Put the excluded character after the range where it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3924 included. To include '^' itself use it as the last character of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3925 option or the end of a range. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3926 "^a-z,#,^" (exclude 'a' to 'z', include '#' and '^')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3927 If the character is '@', all characters where isalpha() returns TRUE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3928 are included. Normally these are the characters a to z and A to Z,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3929 plus accented characters. To include '@' itself use "@-@". Examples:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3930 "@,^a-z" All alphabetic characters, excluding lower
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3931 case letters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3932 "a-z,A-Z,@-@" All letters plus the '@' character.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3933 A comma can be included by using it where a character number is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3934 expected. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3935 "48-57,,,_" Digits, comma and underscore.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3936 A comma can be excluded by prepending a '^'. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3937 " -~,^,,9" All characters from space to '~', excluding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3938 comma, plus <Tab>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3939 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3940
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3941 *'isident'* *'isi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3942 'isident' 'isi' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3943 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3944 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3945 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3946 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3947 The characters given by this option are included in identifiers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3948 Identifiers are used in recognizing environment variables and after a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3949 match of the 'define' option. It is also used for "\i" in a
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
3950 |pattern|. See 'isfname' for a description of the format of this
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3951 option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3952 Careful: If you change this option, it might break expanding
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3953 environment variables. E.g., when '/' is included and Vim tries to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3954 expand "$HOME/.viminfo". Maybe you should change 'iskeyword' instead.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3955
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3956 *'iskeyword'* *'isk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3957 'iskeyword' 'isk' string (Vim default for MS-DOS and Win32:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3958 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3959 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3960 Vi default: "@,48-57,_")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3961 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3962 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3963 Keywords are used in searching and recognizing with many commands:
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3964 "w", "*", "[i", etc. It is also used for "\k" in a |pattern|. See
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3965 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. For C
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3966 programs you could use "a-z,A-Z,48-57,_,.,-,>".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3967 For a help file it is set to all non-blank printable characters except
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3968 '*', '"' and '|' (so that CTRL-] on a command finds the help for that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3969 command).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3970 When the 'lisp' option is on the '-' character is always included.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3971 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3972 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3973
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3974 *'isprint'* *'isp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3975 'isprint' 'isp' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32, OS/2 and Macintosh:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3976 "@,~-255"; otherwise: "@,161-255")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3977 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3978 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3979 The characters given by this option are displayed directly on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3980 screen. It is also used for "\p" in a |pattern|. The characters from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3981 space (ASCII 32) to '~' (ASCII 126) are always displayed directly,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3982 even when they are not included in 'isprint' or excluded. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3983 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3984
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3985 Non-printable characters are displayed with two characters:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3986 0 - 31 "^@" - "^_"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3987 32 - 126 always single characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3988 127 "^?"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3989 128 - 159 "~@" - "~_"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3990 160 - 254 "| " - "|~"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3991 255 "~?"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3992 When 'encoding' is a Unicode one, illegal bytes from 128 to 255 are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3993 displayed as <xx>, with the hexadecimal value of the byte.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3994 When 'display' contains "uhex" all unprintable characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3995 displayed as <xx>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3996 The NonText highlighting will be used for unprintable characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3997 |hl-NonText|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3998
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3999 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4000 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. When a character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4001 is printable but it is not available in the current font, a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4002 replacement character will be shown.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4003 Unprintable and zero-width Unicode characters are displayed as <xxxx>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4004 There is no option to specify these characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4005
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4006 *'joinspaces'* *'js'* *'nojoinspaces'* *'nojs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4007 'joinspaces' 'js' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4008 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4009 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4010 Insert two spaces after a '.', '?' and '!' with a join command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4011 When 'cpoptions' includes the 'j' flag, only do this after a '.'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4012 Otherwise only one space is inserted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4013 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4014
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4015 *'key'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4016 'key' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4017 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4018 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4019 The key that is used for encrypting and decrypting the current buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4020 See |encryption|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4021 Careful: Do not set the key value by hand, someone might see the typed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4022 key. Use the |:X| command. But you can make 'key' empty: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4023 :set key=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4024 < It is not possible to get the value of this option with ":set key" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4025 "echo &key". This is to avoid showing it to someone who shouldn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4026 know. It also means you cannot see it yourself once you have set it,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4027 be careful not to make a typing error!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4028
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4029 *'keymap'* *'kmp'* *E544*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4030 'keymap' 'kmp' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4031 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4032 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4033 {only available when compiled with the |+keymap|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4034 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4035 Name of a keyboard mapping. See |mbyte-keymap|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4036 Setting this option to a valid keymap name has the side effect of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4037 setting 'iminsert' to one, so that the keymap becomes effective.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4038 'imsearch' is also set to one, unless it was -1
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
4039 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4040
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4041 *'keymodel'* *'km'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4042 'keymodel' 'km' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4043 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4044 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4045 List of comma separated words, which enable special things that keys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4046 can do. These values can be used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4047 startsel Using a shifted special key starts selection (either
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4048 Select mode or Visual mode, depending on "key" being
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4049 present in 'selectmode').
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4050 stopsel Using a not-shifted special key stops selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4051 Special keys in this context are the cursor keys, <End>, <Home>,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4052 <PageUp> and <PageDown>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4053 The 'keymodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4054
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4055 *'keywordprg'* *'kp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4056 'keywordprg' 'kp' string (default "man" or "man -s", DOS: ":help",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4057 OS/2: "view /", VMS: "help")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4058 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4059 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4060 Program to use for the |K| command. Environment variables are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4061 expanded |:set_env|. ":help" may be used to access the Vim internal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4062 help. (Note that previously setting the global option to the empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4063 value did this, which is now deprecated.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4064 When "man" is used, Vim will automatically translate a count for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4065 "K" command to a section number. Also for "man -s", in which case the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4066 "-s" is removed when there is no count.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4067 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4068 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4069 :set keywordprg=man\ -s
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4070 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4071 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4072
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4073 *'langmap'* *'lmap'* *E357* *E358*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4074 'langmap' 'lmap' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4075 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4076 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4077 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4078 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4079 This option allows switching your keyboard into a special language
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4080 mode. When you are typing text in Insert mode the characters are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4081 inserted directly. When in command mode the 'langmap' option takes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4082 care of translating these special characters to the original meaning
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4083 of the key. This means you don't have to change the keyboard mode to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4084 be able to execute Normal mode commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4085 This is the opposite of the 'keymap' option, where characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4086 mapped in Insert mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4087 This only works for 8-bit characters. The value of 'langmap' may be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4088 specified with multi-byte characters (e.g., UTF-8), but only the lower
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4089 8 bits of each character will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4090
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
4091 Example (for Greek, in UTF-8): *greek* >
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
4092 :set langmap=ΑA,ΒB,ΨC,ΔD,ΕE,ΦF,ΓG,ΗH,ΙI,ΞJ,ΚK,ΛL,ΜM,ΝN,ΟO,ΠP,QQ,ΡR,ΣS,ΤT,ΘU,ΩV,WW,ΧX,ΥY,ΖZ,αa,βb,ψc,δd,εe,φf,γg,ηh,ιi,ξj,κk,λl,μm,νn,οo,πp,qq,ρr,σs,τt,θu,ωv,ςw,χx,υy,ζz
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4093 < Example (exchanges meaning of z and y for commands): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4094 :set langmap=zy,yz,ZY,YZ
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4095 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4096 The 'langmap' option is a list of parts, separated with commas. Each
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4097 part can be in one of two forms:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4098 1. A list of pairs. Each pair is a "from" character immediately
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4099 followed by the "to" character. Examples: "aA", "aAbBcC".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4100 2. A list of "from" characters, a semi-colon and a list of "to"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4101 characters. Example: "abc;ABC"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4102 Example: "aA,fgh;FGH,cCdDeE"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4103 Special characters need to be preceded with a backslash. These are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4104 ";", ',' and backslash itself.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4105
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4106 This will allow you to activate vim actions without having to switch
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4107 back and forth between the languages. Your language characters will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4108 be understood as normal vim English characters (according to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4109 langmap mappings) in the following cases:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4110 o Normal/Visual mode (commands, buffer/register names, user mappings)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4111 o Insert/Replace Mode: Register names after CTRL-R
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4112 o Insert/Replace Mode: Mappings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4113 Characters entered in Command-line mode will NOT be affected by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4114 this option. Note that this option can be changed at any time
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4115 allowing to switch between mappings for different languages/encodings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4116 Use a mapping to avoid having to type it each time!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4117
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4118 *'langmenu'* *'lm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4119 'langmenu' 'lm' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4120 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4121 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4122 {only available when compiled with the |+menu| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4123 |+multi_lang| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4124 Language to use for menu translation. Tells which file is loaded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4125 from the "lang" directory in 'runtimepath': >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4126 "lang/menu_" . &langmenu . ".vim"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4127 < (without the spaces). For example, to always use the Dutch menus, no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4128 matter what $LANG is set to: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4129 :set langmenu=nl_NL.ISO_8859-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4130 < When 'langmenu' is empty, |v:lang| is used.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
4131 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4132 If your $LANG is set to a non-English language but you do want to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4133 the English menus: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4134 :set langmenu=none
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4135 < This option must be set before loading menus, switching on filetype
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4136 detection or syntax highlighting. Once the menus are defined setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4137 this option has no effect. But you could do this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4138 :source $VIMRUNTIME/delmenu.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4139 :set langmenu=de_DE.ISO_8859-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4140 :source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4141 < Warning: This deletes all menus that you defined yourself!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4142
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4143 *'laststatus'* *'ls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4144 'laststatus' 'ls' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4145 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4146 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4147 The value of this option influences when the last window will have a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4148 status line:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4149 0: never
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4150 1: only if there are at least two windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4151 2: always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4152 The screen looks nicer with a status line if you have several
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4153 windows, but it takes another screen line. |status-line|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4154
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4155 *'lazyredraw'* *'lz'* *'nolazyredraw'* *'nolz'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4156 'lazyredraw' 'lz' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4157 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4158 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4159 When this option is set, the screen will not be redrawn while
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4160 executing macros, registers and other commands that have not been
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4161 typed. Also, updating the window title is postponed. To force an
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4162 update use |:redraw|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4163
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4164 *'linebreak'* *'lbr'* *'nolinebreak'* *'nolbr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4165 'linebreak' 'lbr' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4166 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4167 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4168 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4169 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4170 If on Vim will wrap long lines at a character in 'breakat' rather
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4171 than at the last character that fits on the screen. Unlike
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4172 'wrapmargin' and 'textwidth', this does not insert <EOL>s in the file,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4173 it only affects the way the file is displayed, not its contents. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4174 value of 'showbreak' is used to put in front of wrapped lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4175 This option is not used when the 'wrap' option is off or 'list' is on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4176 Note that <Tab> characters after an <EOL> are mostly not displayed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4177 with the right amount of white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4178
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4179 *'lines'* *E593*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4180 'lines' number (default 24 or terminal height)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4181 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4182 Number of lines of the Vim window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4183 Normally you don't need to set this. It is done automatically by the
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
4184 terminal initialization code. Also see |posix-screen-size|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4185 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4186 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4187 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4188 Vim limits the number of lines to what fits on the screen. You can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4189 use this command to get the tallest window possible: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4190 :set lines=999
571
0ae54f30d5bc updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 557
diff changeset
4191 < Minimum value is 2, maximum value is 1000.
0ae54f30d5bc updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 557
diff changeset
4192 If you get less lines than expected, check the 'guiheadroom' option.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4193 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4194 number of lines of the display, the display may be messed up.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4195
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4196 *'linespace'* *'lsp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4197 'linespace' 'lsp' number (default 0, 1 for Win32 GUI)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4198 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4199 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4200 {only in the GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4201 Number of pixel lines inserted between characters. Useful if the font
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4202 uses the full character cell height, making lines touch each other.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4203 When non-zero there is room for underlining.
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4204 With some fonts there can be too much room between lines (to have
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4205 space for ascents and descents). Then it makes sense to set
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4206 'linespace' to a negative value. This may cause display problems
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4207 though!
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4208
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4209 *'lisp'* *'nolisp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4210 'lisp' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4211 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4212 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4213 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4214 Lisp mode: When <Enter> is typed in insert mode set the indent for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4215 the next line to Lisp standards (well, sort of). Also happens with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4216 "cc" or "S". 'autoindent' must also be on for this to work. The 'p'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4217 flag in 'cpoptions' changes the method of indenting: Vi compatible or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4218 better. Also see 'lispwords'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4219 The '-' character is included in keyword characters. Redefines the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4220 "=" operator to use this same indentation algorithm rather than
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4221 calling an external program if 'equalprg' is empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4222 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4223 {Vi: Does it a little bit differently}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4224
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4225 *'lispwords'* *'lw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4226 'lispwords' 'lw' string (default is very long)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4227 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4228 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4229 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4230 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4231 Comma separated list of words that influence the Lisp indenting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4232 |'lisp'|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4233
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4234 *'list'* *'nolist'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4235 'list' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4236 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4237 List mode: Show tabs as CTRL-I, show end of line with $. Useful to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4238 see the difference between tabs and spaces and for trailing blanks.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4239 Note that this will also affect formatting (set with 'textwidth' or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4240 'wrapmargin') when 'cpoptions' includes 'L'. See 'listchars' for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4241 changing the way tabs are displayed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4242
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4243 *'listchars'* *'lcs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4244 'listchars' 'lcs' string (default "eol:$")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4245 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4246 {not in Vi}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4247 Strings to use in 'list' mode. It is a comma separated list of string
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4248 settings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4249 eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4250 omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4251 line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4252 tab:xy Two characters to be used to show a Tab. The first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4253 char is used once. The second char is repeated to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4254 fill the space that the Tab normally occupies.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4255 "tab:>-" will show a Tab that takes four spaces as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4256 ">---". When omitted, a Tab is show as ^I.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4257 trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4258 trailing spaces are blank.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4259 extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4260 off and the line continues beyond the right of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4261 screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4262 precedes:c Character to show in the first column, when 'wrap'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4263 is off and there is text preceding the character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4264 visible in the first column.
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4265 nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space (character
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4266 0xA0, 160). Left blank when omitted.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4267
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4268 The characters ':' and ',' should not be used. UTF-8 characters can
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4269 be used when 'encoding' is "utf-8", otherwise only printable
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
4270 characters are allowed. All characters must be single width.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4271
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4272 Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4273 :set lcs=tab:>-,trail:-
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4274 :set lcs=tab:>-,eol:<,nbsp:%
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4275 :set lcs=extends:>,precedes:<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4276 < The "NonText" highlighting will be used for "eol", "extends" and
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4277 "precedes". "SpecialKey" for "nbsp", "tab" and "trail".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4278
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4279 *'lpl'* *'nolpl'* *'loadplugins'* *'noloadplugins'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4280 'loadplugins' 'lpl' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4281 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4282 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4283 When on the plugin scripts are loaded when starting up |load-plugins|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4284 This option can be reset in your |vimrc| file to disable the loading
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4285 of plugins.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4286 Note that using the "-u NONE" and "--noplugin" command line arguments
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4287 reset this option. |-u| |--noplugin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4288
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4289 *'magic'* *'nomagic'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4290 'magic' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4291 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4292 Changes the special characters that can be used in search patterns.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4293 See |pattern|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4294 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with using patterns, always keep
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4295 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4296 old Vi scripts. In any other situation write patterns that work when
20
4ac1dce8dd5e updated for version 7.0012
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
4297 'magic' is on. Include "\M" when you want to |/\M|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4298
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4299 *'makeef'* *'mef'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4300 'makeef' 'mef' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4301 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4302 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4303 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4304 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4305 Name of the errorfile for the |:make| command (see |:make_makeprg|)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4306 and the |:grep| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4307 When it is empty, an internally generated temp file will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4308 When "##" is included, it is replaced by a number to make the name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4309 unique. This makes sure that the ":make" command doesn't overwrite an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4310 existing file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4311 NOT used for the ":cf" command. See 'errorfile' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4312 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4313 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4314 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4315 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4316
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4317 *'makeprg'* *'mp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4318 'makeprg' 'mp' string (default "make", VMS: "MMS")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4319 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4320 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4321 Program to use for the ":make" command. See |:make_makeprg|. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4322 option may contain '%' and '#' characters, which are expanded like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4323 when used in a command-line. Environment variables are expanded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4324 |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4325 backslashes. Note that a '|' must be escaped twice: once for ":set"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4326 and once for the interpretation of a command. When you use a filter
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4327 called "myfilter" do it like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4328 :set makeprg=gmake\ \\\|\ myfilter
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4329 < The placeholder "$*" can be given (even multiple times) to specify
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4330 where the arguments will be included, for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4331 :set makeprg=latex\ \\\\nonstopmode\ \\\\input\\{$*}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4332 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4333 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4334
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4335 *'matchpairs'* *'mps'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4336 'matchpairs' 'mps' string (default "(:),{:},[:]")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4337 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4338 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4339 Characters that form pairs. The |%| command jumps from one to the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4340 other. Currently only single character pairs are allowed, and they
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4341 must be different. The characters must be separated by a colon. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4342 pairs must be separated by a comma. Example for including '<' and '>'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4343 (HTML): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4344 :set mps+=<:>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4345
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4346 < A more exotic example, to jump between the '=' and ';' in an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4347 assignment, useful for languages like C and Java: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4348 :au FileType c,cpp,java set mps+==:;
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4349
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4350 < For a more advanced way of using "%", see the matchit.vim plugin in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4351 the $VIMRUNTIME/macros directory. |add-local-help|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4352
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4353 *'matchtime'* *'mat'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4354 'matchtime' 'mat' number (default 5)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4355 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4356 {not in Vi}{in Nvi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4357 Tenths of a second to show the matching paren, when 'showmatch' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4358 set. Note that this is not in milliseconds, like other options that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4359 set a time. This is to be compatible with Nvi.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4360
714
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4361 *'maxcombine'* *'mco'*
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4362 'maxcombine' 'mco' number (default 2)
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4363 global
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4364 {not in Vi}
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4365 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4366 feature}
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4367 The maximum number of combining characters supported for displaying.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4368 Only used when 'encoding' is "utf-8".
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4369 The default is OK for most languages. Hebrew may require 4.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4370 Maximum value is 6.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4371 Even when this option is set to 2 you can still edit text with more
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4372 combining characters, you just can't see them. Use |g8| or |ga|.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4373 See |mbyte-combining|.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4374
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4375 *'maxfuncdepth'* *'mfd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4376 'maxfuncdepth' 'mfd' number (default 100)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4377 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4378 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4379 Maximum depth of function calls for user functions. This normally
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4380 catches endless recursion. When using a recursive function with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4381 more depth, set 'maxfuncdepth' to a bigger number. But this will use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4382 more memory, there is the danger of failing when memory is exhausted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4383 See also |:function|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4384
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4385 *'maxmapdepth'* *'mmd'* *E223*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4386 'maxmapdepth' 'mmd' number (default 1000)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4387 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4388 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4389 Maximum number of times a mapping is done without resulting in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4390 character to be used. This normally catches endless mappings, like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4391 ":map x y" with ":map y x". It still does not catch ":map g wg",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4392 because the 'w' is used before the next mapping is done. See also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4393 |key-mapping|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4394
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4395 *'maxmem'* *'mm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4396 'maxmem' 'mm' number (default between 256 to 5120 (system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4397 dependent) or half the amount of memory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4398 available)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4399 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4400 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4401 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for one buffer. When this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4402 limit is reached allocating extra memory for a buffer will cause
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4403 other memory to be freed. Maximum value 2000000. Use this to work
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4404 without a limit. Also see 'maxmemtot'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4405
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4406 *'maxmempattern'* *'mmp'*
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4407 'maxmempattern' 'mmp' number (default 1000)
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4408 global
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4409 {not in Vi}
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4410 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for pattern matching.
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4411 Maximum value 2000000. Use this to work without a limit.
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4412 *E363*
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4413 When Vim runs into the limit it gives an error message mostly behaves
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4414 like CTRL-C was typed.
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4415 Running into the limit often means that the pattern is very
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4416 inefficient or too complex. This may already happen with the pattern
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4417 "\(.\)*" on a very long line. ".*" works much better.
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4418 Vim may run out of memory before hitting the 'maxmempattern' limit.
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4419
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4420 *'maxmemtot'* *'mmt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4421 'maxmemtot' 'mmt' number (default between 2048 and 10240 (system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4422 dependent) or half the amount of memory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4423 available)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4424 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4425 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4426 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for all buffers together.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4427 Maximum value 2000000. Use this to work without a limit. Also see
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4428 'maxmem'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4429
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4430 *'menuitems'* *'mis'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4431 'menuitems' 'mis' number (default 25)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4432 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4433 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4434 {not available when compiled without the |+menu|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4435 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4436 Maximum number of items to use in a menu. Used for menus that are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4437 generated from a list of items, e.g., the Buffers menu. Changing this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4438 option has no direct effect, the menu must be refreshed first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4439
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4440 *'mkspellmem'* *'msm'*
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4441 'mkspellmem' 'msm' string (default "460000,2000,500")
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4442 global
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4443 {not in Vi}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4444 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4445 feature}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4446 Parameters for |:mkspell|. This tunes when to start compressing the
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4447 word tree. Compression can be slow when there are many words, but
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4448 it's needed to avoid running out of memory. The amount of memory used
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4449 per word depends very much on how similar the words are, that's why
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4450 this tuning is complicated.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4451
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4452 There are three numbers, separated by commas:
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4453 {start},{inc},{added}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4454
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4455 For most languages the uncompressed word tree fits in memory. {start}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4456 gives the amount of memory in Kbyte that can be used before any
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4457 compression is done. It should be a bit smaller than the amount of
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4458 memory that is available to Vim.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4459
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4460 When going over the {start} limit the {inc} number specifies the
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4461 amount of memory in Kbyte that can be allocated before another
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4462 compression is done. A low number means compression is done after
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4463 less words are added, which is slow. A high number means more memory
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4464 will be allocated.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4465
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4466 After doing compression, {added} times 1024 words can be added before
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4467 the {inc} limit is ignored and compression is done when any extra
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4468 amount of memory is needed. A low number means there is a smaller
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4469 chance of hitting the {inc} limit, less memory is used but it's
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4470 slower.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4471
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4472 The languages for which these numbers are important are Italian and
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4473 Hungarian. The default works for when you have about 512 Mbyte. If
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4474 you have 1 Gbyte you could use: >
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4475 :set mkspellmem=900000,3000,800
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4476 < If you have less than 512 Mbyte |:mkspell| may fail for some
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4477 languages, no matter what you set 'mkspellmem' to.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4478
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4479 *'modeline'* *'ml'* *'nomodeline'* *'noml'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4480 'modeline' 'ml' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4481 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4482 *'modelines'* *'mls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4483 'modelines' 'mls' number (default 5)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4484 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4485 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4486 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4487 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4488 no lines are checked. See |modeline|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4489 NOTE: 'modeline' is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4490 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4491
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4492 *'modifiable'* *'ma'* *'nomodifiable'* *'noma'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4493 'modifiable' 'ma' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4494 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4495 {not in Vi} *E21*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4496 When off the buffer contents cannot be changed. The 'fileformat' and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4497 'fileencoding' options also can't be changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4498 Can be reset with the |-M| command line argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4499
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4500 *'modified'* *'mod'* *'nomodified'* *'nomod'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4501 'modified' 'mod' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4502 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4503 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4504 When on, the buffer is considered to be modified. This option is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4505 when:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4506 1. A change was made to the text since it was last written. Using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4507 |undo| command to go back to the original text will reset the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4508 option. But undoing changes that were made before writing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4509 buffer will set the option again, since the text is different from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4510 when it was written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4511 2. 'fileformat' or 'fileencoding' is different from its original
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4512 value. The original value is set when the buffer is read or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4513 written. A ":set nomodified" command also resets the original
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4514 values to the current values and the 'modified' option will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4515 reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4516 When 'buftype' is "nowrite" or "nofile" this option may be set, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4517 will be ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4518
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4519 *'more'* *'nomore'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4520 'more' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4521 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4522 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4523 When on, listings pause when the whole screen is filled. You will get
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4524 the |more-prompt|. When this option is off there are no pauses, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4525 listing continues until finished.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4526 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4527 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4528
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4529 *'mouse'* *E538*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4530 'mouse' string (default "", "a" for GUI, MS-DOS and Win32)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4531 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4532 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4533 Enable the use of the mouse. Only works for certain terminals
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4534 (xterm, MS-DOS, Win32 |win32-mouse|, QNX pterm, and Linux console
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4535 with gpm). For using the mouse in the GUI, see |gui-mouse|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4536 The mouse can be enabled for different modes:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4537 n Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4538 v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4539 i Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4540 c Command-line mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4541 h all previous modes when editing a help file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4542 a all previous modes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4543 r for |hit-enter| and |more-prompt| prompt
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4544 Normally you would enable the mouse in all four modes with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4545 :set mouse=a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4546 < When the mouse is not enabled, the GUI will still use the mouse for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4547 modeless selection. This doesn't move the text cursor.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4548
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4549 See |mouse-using|. Also see |'clipboard'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4550
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4551 Note: When enabling the mouse in a terminal, copy/paste will use the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4552 "* register if there is access to an X-server. The xterm handling of
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4553 the mouse buttons can still be used by keeping the shift key pressed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4554 Also see the 'clipboard' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4555
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4556 *'mousefocus'* *'mousef'* *'nomousefocus'* *'nomousef'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4557 'mousefocus' 'mousef' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4558 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4559 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4560 {only works in the GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4561 The window that the mouse pointer is on is automatically activated.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4562 When changing the window layout or window focus in another way, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4563 mouse pointer is moved to the window with keyboard focus. Off is the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4564 default because it makes using the pull down menus a little goofy, as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4565 a pointer transit may activate a window unintentionally.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4566
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4567 *'mousehide'* *'mh'* *'nomousehide'* *'nomh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4568 'mousehide' 'mh' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4569 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4570 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4571 {only works in the GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4572 When on, the mouse pointer is hidden when characters are typed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4573 The mouse pointer is restored when the mouse is moved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4574
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4575 *'mousemodel'* *'mousem'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4576 'mousemodel' 'mousem' string (default "extend", "popup" for MS-DOS and Win32)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4577 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4578 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4579 Sets the model to use for the mouse. The name mostly specifies what
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4580 the right mouse button is used for:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4581 extend Right mouse button extends a selection. This works
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4582 like in an xterm.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4583 popup Right mouse button pops up a menu. The shifted left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4584 mouse button extends a selection. This works like
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
4585 with Microsoft Windows.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4586 popup_setpos Like "popup", but the cursor will be moved to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4587 position where the mouse was clicked, and thus the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4588 selected operation will act upon the clicked object.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4589 If clicking inside a selection, that selection will
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
4590 be acted upon, i.e. no cursor move. This implies of
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4591 course, that right clicking outside a selection will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4592 end Visual mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4593 Overview of what button does what for each model:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4594 mouse extend popup(_setpos) ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4595 left click place cursor place cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4596 left drag start selection start selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4597 shift-left search word extend selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4598 right click extend selection popup menu (place cursor)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4599 right drag extend selection -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4600 middle click paste paste
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4601
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4602 In the "popup" model the right mouse button produces a pop-up menu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4603 You need to define this first, see |popup-menu|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4604
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4605 Note that you can further refine the meaning of buttons with mappings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4606 See |gui-mouse-mapping|. But mappings are NOT used for modeless
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4607 selection (because that's handled in the GUI code directly).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4608
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4609 The 'mousemodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4610
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4611 *'mouseshape'* *'mouses'* *E547*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4612 'mouseshape' 'mouses' string (default "i:beam,r:beam,s:updown,sd:cross,
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
4613 m:no,ml:up-arrow,v:rightup-arrow")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4614 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4615 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4616 {only available when compiled with the |+mouseshape|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4617 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4618 This option tells Vim what the mouse pointer should look like in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4619 different modes. The option is a comma separated list of parts, much
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4620 like used for 'guicursor'. Each part consist of a mode/location-list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4621 and an argument-list:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4622 mode-list:shape,mode-list:shape,..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4623 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes/locations:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4624 In a normal window: ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4625 n Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4626 v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4627 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4628 if not specified)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4629 o Operator-pending mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4630 i Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4631 r Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4632
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4633 Others: ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4634 c appending to the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4635 ci inserting in the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4636 cr replacing in the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4637 m at the 'Hit ENTER' or 'More' prompts
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4638 ml idem, but cursor in the last line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4639 e any mode, pointer below last window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4640 s any mode, pointer on a status line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4641 sd any mode, while dragging a status line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4642 vs any mode, pointer on a vertical separator line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4643 vd any mode, while dragging a vertical separator line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4644 a everywhere
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4645
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4646 The shape is one of the following:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4647 avail name looks like ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4648 w x arrow Normal mouse pointer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4649 w x blank no pointer at all (use with care!)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4650 w x beam I-beam
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4651 w x updown up-down sizing arrows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4652 w x leftright left-right sizing arrows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4653 w x busy The system's usual busy pointer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4654 w x no The system's usual 'no input' pointer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4655 x udsizing indicates up-down resizing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4656 x lrsizing indicates left-right resizing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4657 x crosshair like a big thin +
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4658 x hand1 black hand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4659 x hand2 white hand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4660 x pencil what you write with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4661 x question big ?
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4662 x rightup-arrow arrow pointing right-up
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4663 w x up-arrow arrow pointing up
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4664 x <number> any X11 pointer number (see X11/cursorfont.h)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4665
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4666 The "avail" column contains a 'w' if the shape is available for Win32,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4667 x for X11.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4668 Any modes not specified or shapes not available use the normal mouse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4669 pointer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4670
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4671 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4672 :set mouseshape=s:udsizing,m:no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4673 < will make the mouse turn to a sizing arrow over the status lines and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4674 indicate no input when the hit-enter prompt is displayed (since
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4675 clicking the mouse has no effect in this state.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4676
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4677 *'mousetime'* *'mouset'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4678 'mousetime' 'mouset' number (default 500)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4679 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4680 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4681 Only for GUI, MS-DOS, Win32 and Unix with xterm. Defines the maximum
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4682 time in msec between two mouse clicks for the second click to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4683 recognized as a multi click.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4684
14
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4685 *'mzquantum'* *'mzq'*
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4686 'mzquantum' 'mzq' number (default 100)
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4687 global
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4688 {not in Vi}
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4689 {not available when compiled without the |+mzscheme|
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4690 feature}
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4691 The number of milliseconds between polls for MzScheme threads.
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4692 Negative or zero value means no thread scheduling.
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4693
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4694 *'nrformats'* *'nf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4695 'nrformats' 'nf' string (default "octal,hex")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4696 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4697 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4698 This defines what bases Vim will consider for numbers when using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4699 CTRL-A and CTRL-X commands for adding to and subtracting from a number
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4700 respectively; see |CTRL-A| for more info on these commands.
625
81fe2ccc1207 updated for version 7.0179
vimboss
parents: 623
diff changeset
4701 alpha If included, single alphabetical characters will be
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4702 incremented or decremented. This is useful for a list with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4703 letter index a), b), etc.
625
81fe2ccc1207 updated for version 7.0179
vimboss
parents: 623
diff changeset
4704 octal If included, numbers that start with a zero will be considered
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4705 to be octal. Example: Using CTRL-A on "007" results in "010".
625
81fe2ccc1207 updated for version 7.0179
vimboss
parents: 623
diff changeset
4706 hex If included, numbers starting with "0x" or "0X" will be
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4707 considered to be hexadecimal. Example: Using CTRL-X on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4708 "0x100" results in "0x0ff".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4709 Numbers which simply begin with a digit in the range 1-9 are always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4710 considered decimal. This also happens for numbers that are not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4711 recognized as octal or hex.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4712
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4713 *'number'* *'nu'* *'nonumber'* *'nonu'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4714 'number' 'nu' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4715 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4716 Print the line number in front of each line. When the 'n' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4717 excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped line will not use the column of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4718 line numbers (this is the default when 'compatible' isn't set).
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4719 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4720 number.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4721 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4722 characters are put before the number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4723 See |hl-LineNr| for the highlighting used for the number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4724
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4725 *'numberwidth'* *'nuw'*
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4726 'numberwidth' 'nuw' number (Vim default: 4 Vi default: 8)
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4727 local to window
14
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4728 {not in Vi}
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4729 {only available when compiled with the |+linebreak|
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
4730 feature}
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4731 Minimal number of columns to use for the line number. Only relevant
694
07d199fe02ed updated for version 7.0209
vimboss
parents: 692
diff changeset
4732 when the 'number' option is set or printing lines with a line number.
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4733 Since one space is always between the number and the text, there is
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4734 one less character for the number itself.
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4735 The value is the minimum width. A bigger width is used when needed to
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4736 fit the highest line number in the buffer. Thus with the Vim default
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4737 of 4 there is room for a line number up to 999. When the buffer has
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4738 1000 lines five columns will be used.
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4739 The minimum value is 1, the maximum value is 10.
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4740 NOTE: 'numberwidth' is reset to 8 when 'compatible' is set.
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4741
523
a7ae7e043e43 updated for version 7.0146
vimboss
parents: 519
diff changeset
4742 *'omnifunc'* *'ofu'*
a7ae7e043e43 updated for version 7.0146
vimboss
parents: 519
diff changeset
4743 'omnifunc' 'ofu' string (default: empty)
502
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4744 local to buffer
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4745 {not in Vi}
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4746 {not available when compiled without the +eval
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4747 or +insert_expand feature}
623
bd2fe62c9d77 updated for version 7.0178
vimboss
parents: 596
diff changeset
4748 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode omni
bd2fe62c9d77 updated for version 7.0178
vimboss
parents: 596
diff changeset
4749 completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O|
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
4750 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
4751 invoked and what it should return.
502
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4752
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
4753
593
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
4754 *'operatorfunc'* *'opfunc'*
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
4755 'operatorfunc' 'opfunc' string (default: empty)
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
4756 global
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
4757 {not in Vi}
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
4758 This option specifies a function to be called by the |g@| operator.
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
4759 See |:map-operator| for more info and an example.
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
4760
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
4761 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
4762 security reasons.
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
4763
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
4764
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4765 *'osfiletype'* *'oft'* *E366*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4766 'osfiletype' 'oft' string (RISC-OS default: "Text",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4767 others default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4768 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4769 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4770 {only available when compiled with the |+osfiletype|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4771 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4772 Some operating systems store extra information about files besides
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4773 name, datestamp and permissions. This option contains the extra
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4774 information, the nature of which will vary between systems.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4775 The value of this option is usually set when the file is loaded, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4776 use to set the file type when file is written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4777 It can affect the pattern matching of the automatic commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4778 |autocmd-osfiletypes|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4779
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4780 *'paragraphs'* *'para'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4781 'paragraphs' 'para' string (default "IPLPPPQPP LIpplpipbp")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4782 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4783 Specifies the nroff macros that separate paragraphs. These are pairs
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4784 of two letters (see |object-motions|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4785
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4786 *'paste'* *'nopaste'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4787 'paste' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4788 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4789 {not in Vi}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4790 Put Vim in Paste mode. This is useful if you want to cut or copy
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4791 some text from one window and paste it in Vim. This will avoid
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4792 unexpected effects.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4793 Setting this option is useful when using Vim in a terminal, where Vim
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4794 cannot distinguish between typed text and pasted text. In the GUI, Vim
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4795 knows about pasting and will mostly do the right thing without 'paste'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4796 being set. The same is true for a terminal where Vim handles the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4797 mouse clicks itself.
148
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
4798 This option is reset when starting the GUI. Thus if you set it in
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
4799 your .vimrc it will work in a terminal, but not in the GUI. Setting
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
4800 'paste' in the GUI has side effects: e.g., the Paste toolbar button
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
4801 will no longer work in Insert mode, because it uses a mapping.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4802 When the 'paste' option is switched on (also when it was already on):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4803 - mapping in Insert mode and Command-line mode is disabled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4804 - abbreviations are disabled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4805 - 'textwidth' is set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4806 - 'wrapmargin' is set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4807 - 'autoindent' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4808 - 'smartindent' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4809 - 'softtabstop' is set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4810 - 'revins' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4811 - 'ruler' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4812 - 'showmatch' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4813 - 'formatoptions' is used like it is empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4814 These options keep their value, but their effect is disabled:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4815 - 'lisp'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4816 - 'indentexpr'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4817 - 'cindent'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4818 NOTE: When you start editing another file while the 'paste' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4819 on, settings from the modelines or autocommands may change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4820 settings again, causing trouble when pasting text. You might want to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4821 set the 'paste' option again.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4822 When the 'paste' option is reset the mentioned options are restored to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4823 the value before the moment 'paste' was switched from off to on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4824 Resetting 'paste' before ever setting it does not have any effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4825 Since mapping doesn't work while 'paste' is active, you need to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4826 the 'pastetoggle' option to toggle the 'paste' option with some key.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4827
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4828 *'pastetoggle'* *'pt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4829 'pastetoggle' 'pt' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4830 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4831 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4832 When non-empty, specifies the key sequence that toggles the 'paste'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4833 option. This is like specifying a mapping: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4834 :map {keys} :set invpaste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4835 < Where {keys} is the value of 'pastetoggle'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4836 The difference is that it will work even when 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4837 'pastetoggle' works in Insert mode and Normal mode, but not in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4838 Command-line mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4839 Mappings are checked first, thus overrule 'pastetoggle'. However,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4840 when 'paste' is on mappings are ignored in Insert mode, thus you can do
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4841 this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4842 :map <F10> :set paste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4843 :map <F11> :set nopaste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4844 :imap <F10> <C-O>:set paste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4845 :imap <F11> <nop>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4846 :set pastetoggle=<F11>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4847 < This will make <F10> start paste mode and <F11> stop paste mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4848 Note that typing <F10> in paste mode inserts "<F10>", since in paste
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4849 mode everything is inserted literally, except the 'pastetoggle' key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4850 sequence.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4851
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4852 *'pex'* *'patchexpr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4853 'patchexpr' 'pex' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4854 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4855 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4856 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4857 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4858 Expression which is evaluated to apply a patch to a file and generate
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4859 the resulting new version of the file. See |diff-patchexpr|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4860
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4861 *'patchmode'* *'pm'* *E206*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4862 'patchmode' 'pm' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4863 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4864 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4865 When non-empty the oldest version of a file is kept. This can be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4866 to keep the original version of a file if you are changing files in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4867 source distribution. Only the first time that a file is written a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4868 copy of the original file will be kept. The name of the copy is the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4869 name of the original file with the string in the 'patchmode' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4870 appended. This option should start with a dot. Use a string like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4871 ".org". 'backupdir' must not be empty for this to work (Detail: The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4872 backup file is renamed to the patchmode file after the new file has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4873 been successfully written, that's why it must be possible to write a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4874 backup file). If there was no file to be backed up, an empty file is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4875 created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4876 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a patchmode file is not made.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4877 Using 'patchmode' for compressed files appends the extension at the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4878 end (e.g., "file.gz.orig"), thus the resulting name isn't always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4879 recognized as a compressed file.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
4880 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4881
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4882 *'path'* *'pa'* *E343* *E345* *E347*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4883 'path' 'pa' string (default on Unix: ".,/usr/include,,"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4884 on OS/2: ".,/emx/include,,"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4885 other systems: ".,,")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4886 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4887 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4888 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4889 |gf|, [f, ]f, ^Wf, |:find| and other commands, provided that the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4890 being searched for has a relative path (not starting with '/'). The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4891 directories in the 'path' option may be relative or absolute.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4892 - Use commas to separate directory names: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4893 :set path=.,/usr/local/include,/usr/include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4894 < - Spaces can also be used to separate directory names (for backwards
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4895 compatibility with version 3.0). To have a space in a directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4896 name, precede it with an extra backslash, and escape the space: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4897 :set path=.,/dir/with\\\ space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4898 < - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with an extra
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4899 backslash: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4900 :set path=.,/dir/with\\,comma
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4901 < - To search relative to the directory of the current file, use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4902 :set path=.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4903 < - To search in the current directory use an empty string between two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4904 commas: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4905 :set path=,,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4906 < - A directory name may end in a ':' or '/'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4907 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4908 - When using |netrw.vim| URLs can be used. For example, adding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4909 "http://www.vim.org" will make ":find index.html" work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4910 - Search upwards and downwards in a directory tree:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4911 1) "*" matches a sequence of characters, e.g.: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4912 :set path=/usr/include/*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4913 < means all subdirectories in /usr/include (but not /usr/include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4914 itself). >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4915 :set path=/usr/*c
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4916 < matches /usr/doc and /usr/src.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4917 2) "**" matches a subtree, up to 100 directories deep. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4918 :set path=/home/user_x/src/**
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4919 < means search in the whole subtree under "/home/usr_x/src".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4920 3) If the path ends with a ';', this path is the startpoint
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4921 for upward search.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4922 See |file-searching| for more info and exact syntax.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4923 {not available when compiled without the |+path_extra| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4924 - Careful with '\' characters, type two to get one in the option: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4925 :set path=.,c:\\include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4926 < Or just use '/' instead: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4927 :set path=.,c:/include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4928 < Don't forget "." or files won't even be found in the same directory as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4929 the file!
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4930 The maximum length is limited. How much depends on the system, mostly
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4931 it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4932 You can check if all the include files are found, using the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4933 'path', see |:checkpath|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4934 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4935 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4936 uses another default. To remove the current directory use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4937 :set path-=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4938 < To add the current directory use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4939 :set path+=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4940 < To use an environment variable, you probably need to replace the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4941 separator. Here is an example to append $INCL, in which directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4942 names are separated with a semi-colon: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4943 :let &path = &path . "," . substitute($INCL, ';', ',', 'g')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4944 < Replace the ';' with a ':' or whatever separator is used. Note that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4945 this doesn't work when $INCL contains a comma or white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4946
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4947 *'preserveindent'* *'pi'* *'nopreserveindent'* *'nopi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4948 'preserveindent' 'pi' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4949 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4950 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4951 When changing the indent of the current line, preserve as much of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4952 indent structure as possible. Normally the indent is replaced by a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4953 series of tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4954 enabled, in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4955 means the indent will preserve as many existing characters as possible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4956 for indenting, and only add additional tabs or spaces as required.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4957 NOTE: When using ">>" multiple times the resulting indent is a mix of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4958 tabs and spaces. You might not like this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4959 NOTE: 'preserveindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4960 Also see 'copyindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4961 Use |:retab| to clean up white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4962
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4963 *'previewheight'* *'pvh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4964 'previewheight' 'pvh' number (default 12)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4965 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4966 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4967 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4968 |+quickfix| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4969 Default height for a preview window. Used for |:ptag| and associated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4970 commands. Used for |CTRL-W_}| when no count is given.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4971
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4972 *'previewwindow'* *'nopreviewwindow'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4973 *'pvw'* *'nopvw'* *E590*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4974 'previewwindow' 'pvw' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4975 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4976 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4977 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4978 |+quickfix| feature}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4979 Identifies the preview window. Only one window can have this option
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4980 set. It's normally not set directly, but by using one of the commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4981 |:ptag|, |:pedit|, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4982
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4983 *'printdevice'* *'pdev'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4984 'printdevice' 'pdev' string (default empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4985 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4986 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4987 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4988 feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4989 The name of the printer to be used for |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4990 See |pdev-option|.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
4991 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
4992 security reasons.
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4993
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4994 *'printencoding'* *'penc'*
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
4995 'printencoding' 'penc' String (default empty, except for some systems)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4996 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4997 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4998 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4999 and |+postscript| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5000 Sets the character encoding used when printing.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5001 See |penc-option|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5002
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5003 *'printexpr'* *'pexpr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5004 'printexpr' 'pexpr' String (default: see below)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5005 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5006 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5007 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5008 and |+postscript| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5009 Expression used to print the PostScript produced with |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5010 See |pexpr-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5011
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5012 *'printfont'* *'pfn'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5013 'printfont' 'pfn' string (default "courier")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5014 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5015 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5016 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5017 feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5018 The name of the font that will be used for |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5019 See |pfn-option|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5020
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5021 *'printheader'* *'pheader'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5022 'printheader' 'pheader' string (default "%<%f%h%m%=Page %N")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5023 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5024 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5025 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5026 feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5027 The format of the header produced in |:hardcopy| output.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5028 See |pheader-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5029
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5030 *'printmbcharset'* *'pmbcs'*
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5031 'printmbcharset' 'pmbcs' string (default "")
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5032 global
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5033 {not in Vi}
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
5034 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
5035 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5036 The CJK character set to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5037 See |pmbcs-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5038
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5039 *'printmbfont'* *'pmbfn'*
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5040 'printmbfont' 'pmbfn' string (default "")
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5041 global
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5042 {not in Vi}
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
5043 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
5044 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5045 List of font names to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5046 See |pmbfn-option|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5047
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5048 *'printoptions'* *'popt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5049 'printoptions' 'popt' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5050 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5051 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5052 {only available when compiled with |+printer| feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5053 List of items that control the format of the output of |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5054 See |popt-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5055
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5056 *'prompt'* *'noprompt'*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5057 'prompt' boolean (default on)
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5058 global
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5059 When on a ":" prompt is used in Ex mode.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5060
766
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5061 *'pumheight'* *'ph'*
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5062 'pumheight' 'ph' number (default 0)
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5063 global
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5064 {not available when compiled without the
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5065 |+insert_expand| feature}
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5066 {not in Vi}
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5067 Determines the maximum number of items to show in the popup menu.
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5068 When zero as much space as available is used.
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5069 |ins-completion-menu|.
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5070
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5071
140
8ecb0db93e9a updated for version 7.0045
vimboss
parents: 99
diff changeset
5072 *'quoteescape'* *'qe'*
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5073 'quoteescape' 'qe' string (default "\")
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5074 local to buffer
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5075 {not in Vi}
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5076 The characters that are used to escape quotes in a string. Used for
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5077 objects like a', a" and a` |a'|.
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5078 When one of the characters in this option is found inside a string,
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5079 the following character will be skipped. The default value makes the
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5080 text "foo\"bar\\" considered to be one string.
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5081
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5082 *'readonly'* *'ro'* *'noreadonly'* *'noro'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5083 'readonly' 'ro' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5084 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5085 If on, writes fail unless you use a '!'. Protects you from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5086 accidentally overwriting a file. Default on when Vim is started
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5087 in read-only mode ("vim -R") or when the executable is called "view".
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
5088 When using ":w!" the 'readonly' option is reset for the current
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
5089 buffer, unless the 'Z' flag is in 'cpoptions'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5090 {not in Vi:} When using the ":view" command the 'readonly' option is
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
5091 set for the newly edited buffer.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5092
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5093 *'remap'* *'noremap'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5094 'remap' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5095 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5096 Allows for mappings to work recursively. If you do not want this for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5097 a single entry, use the :noremap[!] command.
717
2fa8cb05b861 updated for version 7.0218
vimboss
parents: 714
diff changeset
5098 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with Vim scripts, always keep
2fa8cb05b861 updated for version 7.0218
vimboss
parents: 714
diff changeset
5099 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with
2fa8cb05b861 updated for version 7.0218
vimboss
parents: 714
diff changeset
5100 old Vi scripts.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5101
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5102 *'report'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5103 'report' number (default 2)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5104 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5105 Threshold for reporting number of lines changed. When the number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5106 changed lines is more than 'report' a message will be given for most
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5107 ":" commands. If you want it always, set 'report' to 0.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5108 For the ":substitute" command the number of substitutions is used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5109 instead of the number of lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5110
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5111 *'restorescreen'* *'rs'* *'norestorescreen'* *'nors'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5112 'restorescreen' 'rs' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5113 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5114 {not in Vi} {only in Windows 95/NT console version}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5115 When set, the screen contents is restored when exiting Vim. This also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5116 happens when executing external commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5117
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5118 For non-Windows Vim: You can set or reset the 't_ti' and 't_te'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5119 options in your .vimrc. To disable restoring:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5120 set t_ti= t_te=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5121 To enable restoring (for an xterm):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5122 set t_ti=^[7^[[r^[[?47h t_te=^[[?47l^[8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5123 (Where ^[ is an <Esc>, type CTRL-V <Esc> to insert it)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5124
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5125 *'revins'* *'ri'* *'norevins'* *'nori'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5126 'revins' 'ri' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5127 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5128 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5129 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5130 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5131 Inserting characters in Insert mode will work backwards. See "typing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5132 backwards" |ins-reverse|. This option can be toggled with the CTRL-_
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5133 command in Insert mode, when 'allowrevins' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5134 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' or 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5135
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5136 *'rightleft'* *'rl'* *'norightleft'* *'norl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5137 'rightleft' 'rl' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5138 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5139 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5140 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5141 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5142 When on, display orientation becomes right-to-left, i.e., characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5143 that are stored in the file appear from the right to the left.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5144 Using this option, it is possible to edit files for languages that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5145 are written from the right to the left such as Hebrew and Arabic.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5146 This option is per window, so it is possible to edit mixed files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5147 simultaneously, or to view the same file in both ways (this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5148 useful whenever you have a mixed text file with both right-to-left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5149 and left-to-right strings so that both sets are displayed properly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5150 in different windows). Also see |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5151
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5152 *'rightleftcmd'* *'rlc'* *'norightleftcmd'* *'norlc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5153 'rightleftcmd' 'rlc' string (default "search")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5154 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5155 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5156 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5157 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5158 Each word in this option enables the command line editing to work in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5159 right-to-left mode for a group of commands:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5160
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5161 search "/" and "?" commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5162
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5163 This is useful for languages such as Hebrew, Arabic and Farsi.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5164 The 'rightleft' option must be set for 'rightleftcmd' to take effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5165
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5166 *'ruler'* *'ru'* *'noruler'* *'noru'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5167 'ruler' 'ru' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5168 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5169 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5170 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5171 |+cmdline_info| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5172 Show the line and column number of the cursor position, separated by a
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5173 comma. When there is room, the relative position of the displayed
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5174 text in the file is shown on the far right:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5175 Top first line is visible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5176 Bot last line is visible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5177 All first and last line are visible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5178 45% relative position in the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5179 If 'rulerformat' is set, it will determine the contents of the ruler.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5180 Each window has its own ruler. If a window has a status line, the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5181 ruler is shown there. Otherwise it is shown in the last line of the
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5182 screen. If the statusline is given by 'statusline' (i.e. not empty),
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5183 this option takes precedence over 'ruler' and 'rulerformat'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5184 If the number of characters displayed is different from the number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5185 bytes in the text (e.g., for a TAB or a multi-byte character), both
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5186 the text column (byte number) and the screen column are shown,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5187 separated with a dash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5188 For an empty line "0-1" is shown.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5189 For an empty buffer the line number will also be zero: "0,0-1".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5190 This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5191 If you don't want to see the ruler all the time but want to know where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5192 you are, use "g CTRL-G" |g_CTRL-G|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5193 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5194
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5195 *'rulerformat'* *'ruf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5196 'rulerformat' 'ruf' string (default empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5197 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5198 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5199 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5200 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5201 When this option is not empty, it determines the content of the ruler
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5202 string, as displayed for the 'ruler' option.
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
5203 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5204 The default ruler width is 17 characters. To make the ruler 15
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5205 characters wide, put "%15(" at the start and "%)" at the end.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5206 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5207 :set rulerformat=%15(%c%V\ %p%%%)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5208 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5209 *'runtimepath'* *'rtp'* *vimfiles*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5210 'runtimepath' 'rtp' string (default:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5211 Unix: "$HOME/.vim,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5212 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5213 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5214 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5215 $HOME/.vim/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5216 Amiga: "home:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5217 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5218 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5219 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5220 home:vimfiles/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5221 PC, OS/2: "$HOME/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5222 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5223 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5224 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5225 $HOME/vimfiles/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5226 Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5227 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5228 $VIM:vimfiles:after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5229 RISC-OS: "Choices:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5230 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5231 Choices:vimfiles/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5232 VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5233 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5234 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5235 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5236 sys$login:vimfiles/after")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5237 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5238 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5239 This is a list of directories which will be searched for runtime
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5240 files:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5241 filetype.vim filetypes by file name |new-filetype|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5242 scripts.vim filetypes by file contents |new-filetype-scripts|
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
5243 autoload/ automatically loaded scripts |autoload-functions|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5244 colors/ color scheme files |:colorscheme|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5245 compiler/ compiler files |:compiler|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5246 doc/ documentation |write-local-help|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5247 ftplugin/ filetype plugins |write-filetype-plugin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5248 indent/ indent scripts |indent-expression|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5249 keymap/ key mapping files |mbyte-keymap|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5250 lang/ menu translations |:menutrans|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5251 menu.vim GUI menus |menu.vim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5252 plugin/ plugin scripts |write-plugin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5253 print/ files for printing |postscript-print-encoding|
650
662e40bd2be1 updated for version 7.0191
vimboss
parents: 648
diff changeset
5254 spell/ spell checking files |spell|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5255 syntax/ syntax files |mysyntaxfile|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5256 tutor/ files for vimtutor |tutor|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5257
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5258 And any other file searched for with the |:runtime| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5259
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5260 The defaults for most systems are setup to search five locations:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5261 1. In your home directory, for your personal preferences.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5262 2. In a system-wide Vim directory, for preferences from the system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5263 administrator.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5264 3. In $VIMRUNTIME, for files distributed with Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5265 *after-directory*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5266 4. In the "after" directory in the system-wide Vim directory. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5267 for the system administrator to overrule or add to the distributed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5268 defaults (rarely needed)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5269 5. In the "after" directory in your home directory. This is for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5270 personal preferences to overrule or add to the distributed defaults
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5271 or system-wide settings (rarely needed).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5272
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5273 Note that, unlike 'path', no wildcards like "**" are allowed. Normal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5274 wildcards are allowed, but can significantly slow down searching for
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5275 runtime files. For speed, use as few items as possible and avoid
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5276 wildcards.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5277 See |:runtime|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5278 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5279 :set runtimepath=~/vimruntime,/mygroup/vim,$VIMRUNTIME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5280 < This will use the directory "~/vimruntime" first (containing your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5281 personal Vim runtime files), then "/mygroup/vim" (shared between a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5282 group of people) and finally "$VIMRUNTIME" (the distributed runtime
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5283 files).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5284 You probably should always include $VIMRUNTIME somewhere, to use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5285 distributed runtime files. You can put a directory before $VIMRUNTIME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5286 to find files which replace a distributed runtime files. You can put
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5287 a directory after $VIMRUNTIME to find files which add to distributed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5288 runtime files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5289 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5290 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5291
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5292 *'scroll'* *'scr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5293 'scroll' 'scr' number (default: half the window height)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5294 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5295 Number of lines to scroll with CTRL-U and CTRL-D commands. Will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5296 set to half the number of lines in the window when the window size
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5297 changes. If you give a count to the CTRL-U or CTRL-D command it will
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5298 be used as the new value for 'scroll'. Reset to half the window
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5299 height with ":set scroll=0". {Vi is a bit different: 'scroll' gives
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5300 the number of screen lines instead of file lines, makes a difference
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5301 when lines wrap}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5302
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5303 *'scrollbind'* *'scb'* *'noscrollbind'* *'noscb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5304 'scrollbind' 'scb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5305 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5306 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5307 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5308 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5309 See also |scroll-binding|. When this option is set, the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5310 window scrolls as other scrollbind windows (windows that also have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5311 this option set) scroll. This option is useful for viewing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5312 differences between two versions of a file, see 'diff'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5313 See |'scrollopt'| for options that determine how this option should be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5314 interpreted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5315 This option is mostly reset when splitting a window to edit another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5316 file. This means that ":split | edit file" results in two windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5317 with scroll-binding, but ":split file" does not.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5318
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5319 *'scrolljump'* *'sj'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5320 'scrolljump' 'sj' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5321 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5322 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5323 Minimal number of lines to scroll when the cursor gets off the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5324 screen (e.g., with "j"). Not used for scroll commands (e.g., CTRL-E,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5325 CTRL-D). Useful if your terminal scrolls very slowly.
532
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
5326 When set to a negative number from -1 to -100 this is used as the
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
5327 percentage of the window height. Thus -50 scrolls half the window
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
5328 height.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5329 NOTE: This option is set to 1 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5330
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5331 *'scrolloff'* *'so'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5332 'scrolloff' 'so' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5333 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5334 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5335 Minimal number of screen lines to keep above and below the cursor.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5336 This will make some context visible around where you are working. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5337 you set it to a very large value (999) the cursor line will always be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5338 in the middle of the window (except at the start or end of the file or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5339 when long lines wrap).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5340 For scrolling horizontally see 'sidescrolloff'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5341 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5342
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5343 *'scrollopt'* *'sbo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5344 'scrollopt' 'sbo' string (default "ver,jump")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5345 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5346 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5347 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5348 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5349 This is a comma-separated list of words that specifies how
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
5350 'scrollbind' windows should behave. 'sbo' stands for ScrollBind
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
5351 Options.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5352 The following words are available:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5353 ver Bind vertical scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5354 hor Bind horizontal scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5355 jump Applies to the offset between two windows for vertical
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5356 scrolling. This offset is the difference in the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5357 displayed line of the bound windows. When moving
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5358 around in a window, another 'scrollbind' window may
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5359 reach a position before the start or after the end of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5360 the buffer. The offset is not changed though, when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5361 moving back the 'scrollbind' window will try to scroll
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5362 to the desired position when possible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5363 When now making that window the current one, two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5364 things can be done with the relative offset:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5365 1. When "jump" is not included, the relative offset is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5366 adjusted for the scroll position in the new current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5367 window. When going back to the other window, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5368 the new relative offset will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5369 2. When "jump" is included, the other windows are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5370 scrolled to keep the same relative offset. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5371 going back to the other window, it still uses the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5372 same relative offset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5373 Also see |scroll-binding|.
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
5374 When 'diff' mode is active there always is vertical scroll binding,
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
5375 even when "ver" isn't there.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5376
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5377 *'sections'* *'sect'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5378 'sections' 'sect' string (default "SHNHH HUnhsh")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5379 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5380 Specifies the nroff macros that separate sections. These are pairs of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5381 two letters (See |object-motions|). The default makes a section start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5382 at the nroff macros ".SH", ".NH", ".H", ".HU", ".nh" and ".sh".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5383
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5384 *'secure'* *'nosecure'* *E523*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5385 'secure' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5386 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5387 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5388 When on, ":autocmd", shell and write commands are not allowed in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5389 ".vimrc" and ".exrc" in the current directory and map commands are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5390 displayed. Switch it off only if you know that you will not run into
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5391 problems, or when the 'exrc' option is off. On Unix this option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5392 only used if the ".vimrc" or ".exrc" is not owned by you. This can be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5393 dangerous if the systems allows users to do a "chown". You better set
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5394 'secure' at the end of your ~/.vimrc then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5395 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5396 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5397
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5398 *'selection'* *'sel'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5399 'selection' 'sel' string (default "inclusive")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5400 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5401 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5402 This option defines the behavior of the selection. It is only used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5403 in Visual and Select mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5404 Possible values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5405 value past line inclusive ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5406 old no yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5407 inclusive yes yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5408 exclusive yes no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5409 "past line" means that the cursor is allowed to be positioned one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5410 character past the line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5411 "inclusive" means that the last character of the selection is included
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5412 in an operation. For example, when "x" is used to delete the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5413 selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5414 Note that when "exclusive" is used and selecting from the end
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5415 backwards, you cannot include the last character of a line, when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5416 starting in Normal mode and 'virtualedit' empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5417
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5418 The 'selection' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5419
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5420 *'selectmode'* *'slm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5421 'selectmode' 'slm' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5422 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5423 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5424 This is a comma separated list of words, which specifies when to start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5425 Select mode instead of Visual mode, when a selection is started.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5426 Possible values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5427 mouse when using the mouse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5428 key when using shifted special keys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5429 cmd when using "v", "V" or CTRL-V
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5430 See |Select-mode|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5431 The 'selectmode' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5432
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5433 *'sessionoptions'* *'ssop'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5434 'sessionoptions' 'ssop' string (default: "blank,buffers,curdir,folds,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5435 help,options,winsize")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5436 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5437 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5438 {not available when compiled without the +mksession
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5439 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5440 Changes the effect of the |:mksession| command. It is a comma
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5441 separated list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5442 something:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5443 word save and restore ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5444 blank empty windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5445 buffers hidden and unloaded buffers, not just those in windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5446 curdir the current directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5447 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5448 fold options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5449 globals global variables that start with an uppercase letter
75
388f285bda1b updated for version 7.0031
vimboss
parents: 41
diff changeset
5450 and contain at least one lowercase letter. Only
388f285bda1b updated for version 7.0031
vimboss
parents: 41
diff changeset
5451 String and Number types are stored.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5452 help the help window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5453 localoptions options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5454 global values for local options)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5455 options all options and mappings (also global values for local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5456 options)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5457 resize size of the Vim window: 'lines' and 'columns'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5458 sesdir the directory in which the session file is located
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5459 will become the current directory (useful with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5460 projects accessed over a network from different
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5461 systems)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5462 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5463 slashes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5464 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5465 on Windows or DOS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5466 winpos position of the whole Vim window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5467 winsize window sizes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5468
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5469 Don't include both "curdir" and "sesdir".
674
4b8583e82cb8 updated for version 7.0201
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
5470 There is no option to include tab pages yet, only the current tab page
4b8583e82cb8 updated for version 7.0201
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
5471 is stored in the session. |tab-page|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5472 When "curdir" nor "sesdir" is included, file names are stored with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5473 absolute paths.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5474 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing session files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5475 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5476 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5477
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5478 *'shell'* *'sh'* *E91*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5479 'shell' 'sh' string (default $SHELL or "sh",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5480 MS-DOS and Win32: "command.com" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5481 "cmd.exe", OS/2: "cmd")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5482 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5483 Name of the shell to use for ! and :! commands. When changing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5484 value also check these options: 'shelltype', 'shellpipe', 'shellslash'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5485 'shellredir', 'shellquote', 'shellxquote' and 'shellcmdflag'.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5486 It is allowed to give an argument to the command, e.g. "csh -f".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5487 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5488 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5489 If the name of the shell contains a space, you might need to enclose
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5490 it in quotes. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5491 :set shell=\"c:\program\ files\unix\sh.exe\"\ -f
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5492 < Note the backslash before each quote (to avoid starting a comment) and
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5493 each space (to avoid ending the option value). Also note that the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5494 "-f" is not inside the quotes, because it is not part of the command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5495 name. And Vim automagically recognizes the backslashes that are path
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5496 separators.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5497 For Dos 32 bits (DJGPP), you can set the $DJSYSFLAGS environment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5498 variable to change the way external commands are executed. See the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5499 libc.inf file of DJGPP.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5500 Under MS-Windows, when the executable ends in ".com" it must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5501 included. Thus setting the shell to "command.com" or "4dos.com"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5502 works, but "command" and "4dos" do not work for all commands (e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5503 filtering).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5504 For unknown reasons, when using "4dos.com" the current directory is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5505 changed to "C:\". To avoid this set 'shell' like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5506 :set shell=command.com\ /c\ 4dos
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5507 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5508 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5509
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5510 *'shellcmdflag'* *'shcf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5511 'shellcmdflag' 'shcf' string (default: "-c", MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5512 does not contain "sh" somewhere: "/c")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5513 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5514 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5515 Flag passed to the shell to execute "!" and ":!" commands; e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5516 "bash.exe -c ls" or "command.com /c dir". For the MS-DOS-like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5517 systems, the default is set according to the value of 'shell', to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5518 reduce the need to set this option by the user. It's not used for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5519 OS/2 (EMX figures this out itself). See |option-backslash| about
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5520 including spaces and backslashes. See |dos-shell|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5521 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5522 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5523
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5524 *'shellpipe'* *'sp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5525 'shellpipe' 'sp' string (default ">", "| tee", "|& tee" or "2>&1| tee")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5526 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5527 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5528 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5529 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5530 String to be used to put the output of the ":make" command in the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5531 error file. See also |:make_makeprg|. See |option-backslash| about
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5532 including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5533 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5534 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5535 of this option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5536 For the Amiga and MS-DOS the default is ">". The output is directly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5537 saved in a file and not echoed to the screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5538 For Unix the default it "| tee". The stdout of the compiler is saved
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5539 in a file and echoed to the screen. If the 'shell' option is "csh" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5540 "tcsh" after initializations, the default becomes "|& tee". If the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5541 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "zsh" or "bash" the default becomes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5542 "2>&1| tee". This means that stderr is also included.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5543 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5544 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5545 there, the 'shellpipe' option changes automatically, unless it was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5546 explicitly set before.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5547 When 'shellpipe' is set to an empty string, no redirection of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5548 ":make" output will be done. This is useful if you use a 'makeprg'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5549 that writes to 'makeef' by itself. If you want no piping, but do
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5550 want to include the 'makeef', set 'shellpipe' to a single space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5551 Don't forget to precede the space with a backslash: ":set sp=\ ".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5552 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5553 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5554 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5555 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5556
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5557 *'shellquote'* *'shq'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5558 'shellquote' 'shq' string (default: ""; MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5559 contains "sh" somewhere: "\"")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5560 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5561 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5562 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5563 the "!" and ":!" commands. The redirection is kept outside of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5564 quoting. See 'shellxquote' to include the redirection. It's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5565 probably not useful to set both options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5566 This is an empty string by default. Only known to be useful for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5567 third-party shells on MS-DOS-like systems, such as the MKS Korn Shell
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5568 or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted according
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5569 the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option by the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5570 user. See |dos-shell|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5571 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5572 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5573
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5574 *'shellredir'* *'srr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5575 'shellredir' 'srr' string (default ">", ">&" or ">%s 2>&1")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5576 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5577 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5578 String to be used to put the output of a filter command in a temporary
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5579 file. See also |:!|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5580 and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5581 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5582 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5583 of this option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5584 The default is ">". For Unix, if the 'shell' option is "csh", "tcsh"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5585 or "zsh" during initializations, the default becomes ">&". If the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5586 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh" or "bash" the default becomes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5587 ">%s 2>&1". This means that stderr is also included.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5588 For Win32, the Unix checks are done and additionally "cmd" is checked
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5589 for, which makes the default ">%s 2>&1". Also, the same names with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5590 ".exe" appended are checked for.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5591 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5592 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5593 there, the 'shellredir' option changes automatically unless it was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5594 explicitly set before.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5595 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5596 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5597 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5598 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5599
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5600 *'shellslash'* *'ssl'* *'noshellslash'* *'nossl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5601 'shellslash' 'ssl' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5602 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5603 {not in Vi} {only for MSDOS, MS-Windows and OS/2}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5604 When set, a forward slash is used when expanding file names. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5605 useful when a Unix-like shell is used instead of command.com or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5606 cmd.exe. Backward slashes can still be typed, but they are changed to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5607 forward slashes by Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5608 Note that setting or resetting this option has no effect for some
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5609 existing file names, thus this option needs to be set before opening
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5610 any file for best results. This might change in the future.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5611 'shellslash' only works when a backslash can be used as a path
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5612 separator. To test if this is so use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5613 if exists('+shellslash')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5614 <
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5615 *'shelltemp'* *'stmp'* *'noshelltemp'* *'nostmp'*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5616 'shelltemp' 'stmp' boolean (Vi default off, Vim default on)
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5617 global
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5618 {not in Vi}
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5619 When on, use temp files for shell commands. When off use a pipe.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5620 When using a pipe is not possible temp files are used anyway.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5621 Currently a pipe is only supported on Unix. You can check it with: >
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5622 :if has("filterpipe")
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5623 < The advantage of using a pipe is that nobody can read the temp file
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5624 and the 'shell' command does not need to support redirection.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5625 The advantage of using a temp file is that the file type and encoding
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5626 can be detected.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5627 The |FilterReadPre|, |FilterReadPost| and |FilterWritePre|,
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5628 |FilterWritePost| autocommands event are not triggered when
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5629 'shelltemp' is off.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5630
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5631 *'shelltype'* *'st'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5632 'shelltype' 'st' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5633 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5634 {not in Vi} {only for the Amiga}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5635 On the Amiga this option influences the way how the commands work
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5636 which use a shell.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5637 0 and 1: always use the shell
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5638 2 and 3: use the shell only to filter lines
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5639 4 and 5: use shell only for ':sh' command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5640 When not using the shell, the command is executed directly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5641
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5642 0 and 2: use "shell 'shellcmdflag' cmd" to start external commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5643 1 and 3: use "shell cmd" to start external commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5644
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5645 *'shellxquote'* *'sxq'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5646 'shellxquote' 'sxq' string (default: "";
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5647 for Win32, when 'shell' contains "sh"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5648 somewhere: "\""
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5649 for Unix, when using system(): "\"")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5650 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5651 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5652 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5653 the "!" and ":!" commands. Includes the redirection. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5654 'shellquote' to exclude the redirection. It's probably not useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5655 to set both options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5656 This is an empty string by default. Known to be useful for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5657 third-party shells when using the Win32 version, such as the MKS Korn
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5658 Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5659 according the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5660 by the user. See |dos-shell|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5661 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5662 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5663
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5664 *'shiftround'* *'sr'* *'noshiftround'* *'nosr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5665 'shiftround' 'sr' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5666 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5667 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5668 Round indent to multiple of 'shiftwidth'. Applies to > and <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5669 commands. CTRL-T and CTRL-D in Insert mode always round the indent to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5670 a multiple of 'shiftwidth' (this is Vi compatible).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5671 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5672
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5673 *'shiftwidth'* *'sw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5674 'shiftwidth' 'sw' number (default 8)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5675 local to buffer
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5676 Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5677 |'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5678
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5679 *'shortmess'* *'shm'*
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5680 'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToO", Vi default: "",
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5681 POSIX default: "A")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5682 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5683 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5684 This option helps to avoid all the |hit-enter| prompts caused by file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5685 messages, for example with CTRL-G, and to avoid some other messages.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5686 It is a list of flags:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5687 flag meaning when present ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5688 f use "(3 of 5)" instead of "(file 3 of 5)"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5689 i use "[noeol]" instead of "[Incomplete last line]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5690 l use "999L, 888C" instead of "999 lines, 888 characters"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5691 m use "[+]" instead of "[Modified]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5692 n use "[New]" instead of "[New File]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5693 r use "[RO]" instead of "[readonly]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5694 w use "[w]" instead of "written" for file write message
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5695 and "[a]" instead of "appended" for ':w >> file' command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5696 x use "[dos]" instead of "[dos format]", "[unix]" instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5697 "[unix format]" and "[mac]" instead of "[mac format]".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5698 a all of the above abbreviations
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5699
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5700 o overwrite message for writing a file with subsequent message
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5701 for reading a file (useful for ":wn" or when 'autowrite' on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5702 O message for reading a file overwrites any previous message.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5703 Also for quickfix message (e.g., ":cn").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5704 s don't give "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" or "search
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5705 hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5706 t truncate file message at the start if it is too long to fit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5707 on the command-line, "<" will appear in the left most column.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5708 Ignored in Ex mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5709 T truncate other messages in the middle if they are too long to
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5710 fit on the command line. "..." will appear in the middle.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5711 Ignored in Ex mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5712 W don't give "written" or "[w]" when writing a file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5713 A don't give the "ATTENTION" message when an existing swap file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5714 is found.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5715 I don't give the intro message when starting Vim |:intro|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5716
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5717 This gives you the opportunity to avoid that a change between buffers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5718 requires you to hit <Enter>, but still gives as useful a message as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5719 possible for the space available. To get the whole message that you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5720 would have got with 'shm' empty, use ":file!"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5721 Useful values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5722 shm= No abbreviation of message.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5723 shm=a Abbreviation, but no loss of information.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5724 shm=at Abbreviation, and truncate message when necessary.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5725
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5726 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5727 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5728
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5729 *'shortname'* *'sn'* *'noshortname'* *'nosn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5730 'shortname' 'sn' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5731 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5732 {not in Vi, not in MS-DOS versions}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5733 Filenames are assumed to be 8 characters plus one extension of 3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5734 characters. Multiple dots in file names are not allowed. When this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5735 option is on, dots in file names are replaced with underscores when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5736 adding an extension (".~" or ".swp"). This option is not available
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5737 for MS-DOS, because then it would always be on. This option is useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5738 when editing files on an MS-DOS compatible filesystem, e.g., messydos
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5739 or crossdos. When running the Win32 GUI version under Win32s, this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5740 option is always on by default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5741
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5742 *'showbreak'* *'sbr'* *E595*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5743 'showbreak' 'sbr' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5744 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5745 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5746 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5747 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5748 String to put at the start of lines that have been wrapped. Useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5749 values are "> " or "+++ ".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5750 Only printable single-cell characters are allowed, excluding <Tab> and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5751 comma (in a future version the comma might be used to separate the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5752 part that is shown at the end and at the start of a line).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5753 The characters are highlighted according to the '@' flag in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5754 'highlight'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5755 Note that tabs after the showbreak will be displayed differently.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5756 If you want the 'showbreak' to appear in between line numbers, add the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5757 "n" flag to 'cpoptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5758
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5759 *'showcmd'* *'sc'* *'noshowcmd'* *'nosc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5760 'showcmd' 'sc' boolean (Vim default: on, off for Unix, Vi default:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5761 off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5762 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5763 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5764 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5765 |+cmdline_info| feature}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5766 Show (partial) command in status line. Set this option off if your
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5767 terminal is slow.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5768 In Visual mode the size of the selected area is shown:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5769 - When selecting characters within a line, the number of characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5770 - When selecting more than one line, the number of lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5771 - When selecting a block, the size in screen characters: linesxcolumns.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5772 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5773 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5774
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5775 *'showfulltag'* *'sft'* *'noshowfulltag'* *'nosft'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5776 'showfulltag' 'sft' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5777 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5778 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5779 When completing a word in insert mode (see |ins-completion|) from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5780 tags file, show both the tag name and a tidied-up form of the search
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5781 pattern (if there is one) as possible matches. Thus, if you have
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5782 matched a C function, you can see a template for what arguments are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5783 required (coding style permitting).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5784
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5785 *'showmatch'* *'sm'* *'noshowmatch'* *'nosm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5786 'showmatch' 'sm' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5787 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5788 When a bracket is inserted, briefly jump to the matching one. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5789 jump is only done if the match can be seen on the screen. The time to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5790 show the match can be set with 'matchtime'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5791 A Beep is given if there is no match (no matter if the match can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5792 seen or not). This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5793 When the 'm' flag is not included in 'cpoptions', typing a character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5794 will immediately move the cursor back to where it belongs.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5795 See the "sm" field in 'guicursor' for setting the cursor shape and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5796 blinking when showing the match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5797 The 'matchpairs' option can be used to specify the characters to show
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5798 matches for. 'rightleft' and 'revins' are used to look for opposite
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5799 matches.
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
5800 Also see the matchparen plugin for highlighting the match when moving
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
5801 around |pi_paren.txt|.
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
5802 Note: Use of the short form is rated PG.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5803
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5804 *'showmode'* *'smd'* *'noshowmode'* *'nosmd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5805 'showmode' 'smd' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5806 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5807 If in Insert, Replace or Visual mode put a message on the last line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5808 Use the 'M' flag in 'highlight' to set the type of highlighting for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5809 this message.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5810 When |XIM| may be used the message will include "XIM". But this
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5811 doesn't mean XIM is really active, especially when 'imactivatekey' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5812 not set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5813 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5814 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5815
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
5816 *'showtabline'* *'stal'*
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
5817 'showtabline' 'stal' number (default 1)
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
5818 global
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
5819 {not in Vi}
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
5820 {not available when compiled without the +windows
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
5821 feature}
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
5822 The value of this option specifies when the line with tab page labels
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
5823 will be displayed:
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
5824 0: never
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
5825 1: only if there are at least two tab pages
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
5826 2: always
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
5827 This is both for the GUI and non-GUI implementation of the tab pages
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
5828 line.
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
5829 See |tab-page| for more information about tab pages.
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
5830
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5831 *'sidescroll'* *'ss'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5832 'sidescroll' 'ss' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5833 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5834 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5835 The minimal number of columns to scroll horizontally. Used only when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5836 the 'wrap' option is off and the cursor is moved off of the screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5837 When it is zero the cursor will be put in the middle of the screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5838 When using a slow terminal set it to a large number or 0. When using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5839 a fast terminal use a small number or 1. Not used for "zh" and "zl"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5840 commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5841
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5842 *'sidescrolloff'* *'siso'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5843 'sidescrolloff' 'siso' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5844 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5845 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5846 The minimal number of screen columns to keep to the left and to the
534
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
5847 right of the cursor if 'nowrap' is set. Setting this option to a
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
5848 value greater than 0 while having |'sidescroll'| also at a non-zero
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
5849 value makes some context visible in the line you are scrolling in
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
5850 horizontally (except at beginning of the line). Setting this option
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
5851 to a large value (like 999) has the effect of keeping the cursor
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
5852 horizontally centered in the window, as long as one does not come too
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
5853 close to the beginning of the line.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5854 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5855
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5856 Example: Try this together with 'sidescroll' and 'listchars' as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5857 in the following example to never allow the cursor to move
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5858 onto the "extends" character:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5859
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5860 :set nowrap sidescroll=1 listchars=extends:>,precedes:<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5861 :set sidescrolloff=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5862
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5863
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5864 *'smartcase'* *'scs'* *'nosmartcase'* *'noscs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5865 'smartcase' 'scs' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5866 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5867 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5868 Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5869 case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5870 'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N",
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5871 ":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc.. After
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5872 "*" and "#" you can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5873 recalling the search pattern from history and hitting <Enter>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5874 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5875
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5876 *'smartindent'* *'si'* *'nosmartindent'* *'nosi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5877 'smartindent' 'si' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5878 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5879 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5880 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5881 |+smartindent| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5882 Do smart autoindenting when starting a new line. Works for C-like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5883 programs, but can also be used for other languages. 'cindent' does
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5884 something like this, works better in most cases, but is more strict,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5885 see |C-indenting|. When 'cindent' is on, setting 'si' has no effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5886 'indentexpr' is a more advanced alternative.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5887 Normally 'autoindent' should also be on when using 'smartindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5888 An indent is automatically inserted:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5889 - After a line ending in '{'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5890 - After a line starting with a keyword from 'cinwords'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5891 - Before a line starting with '}' (only with the "O" command).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5892 When typing '}' as the first character in a new line, that line is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5893 given the same indent as the matching '{'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5894 When typing '#' as the first character in a new line, the indent for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5895 that line is removed, the '#' is put in the first column. The indent
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5896 is restored for the next line. If you don't want this, use this
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5897 mapping: ":inoremap # X^H#", where ^H is entered with CTRL-V CTRL-H.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5898 When using the ">>" command, lines starting with '#' are not shifted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5899 right.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5900 NOTE: 'smartindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set. When 'paste'
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5901 is set smart indenting is disabled.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5902
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5903 *'smarttab'* *'sta'* *'nosmarttab'* *'nosta'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5904 'smarttab' 'sta' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5905 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5906 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5907 When on, a <Tab> in front of a line inserts blanks according to
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
5908 'shiftwidth'. 'tabstop' or 'softtabstop' is used in other places. A
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
5909 <BS> will delete a 'shiftwidth' worth of space at the start of the
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
5910 line.
650
662e40bd2be1 updated for version 7.0191
vimboss
parents: 648
diff changeset
5911 When off, a <Tab> always inserts blanks according to 'tabstop' or
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
5912 'softtabstop'. 'shiftwidth' is only used for shifting text left or
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
5913 right |shift-left-right|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5914 What gets inserted (a Tab or spaces) depends on the 'expandtab'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5915 option. Also see |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
5916 number of spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5917 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5918
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5919 *'softtabstop'* *'sts'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5920 'softtabstop' 'sts' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5921 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5922 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5923 Number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while performing editing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5924 operations, like inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5925 <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mix of spaces and <Tab>s is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5926 used. This is useful to keep the 'ts' setting at its standard value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5927 of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5928 commands like "x" still work on the actual characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5929 When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5930 'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5931 See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5932 spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5933 The 'L' flag in 'cpoptions' changes how tabs are used when 'list' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5934 set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5935 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5936
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5937 *'spell'* *'nospell'*
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5938 'spell' boolean (default off)
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5939 local to window
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5940 {not in Vi}
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5941 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5942 feature}
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5943 When on spell checking will be done. See |spell|.
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
5944 The languages are specified with 'spelllang'.
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5945
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5946 *'spellcapcheck'* *'spc'*
389
4fe8e1a7758e updated for version 7.0102
vimboss
parents: 386
diff changeset
5947 'spellcapcheck' 'spc' string (default "[.?!]\_[\])'" \t]\+")
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5948 local to buffer
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5949 {not in Vi}
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5950 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5951 feature}
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5952 Pattern to locate the end of a sentence. The following word will be
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5953 checked to start with a capital letter. If not then it is highlighted
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
5954 with SpellCap |hl-SpellCap| (unless the word is also badly spelled).
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5955 When this check is not wanted make this option empty.
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5956 Only used when 'spell' is set.
389
4fe8e1a7758e updated for version 7.0102
vimboss
parents: 386
diff changeset
5957 Be careful with special characters, see |option-backslash| about
4fe8e1a7758e updated for version 7.0102
vimboss
parents: 386
diff changeset
5958 including spaces and backslashes.
480
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
5959 To set this option automatically depending on the language, see
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
5960 |set-spc-auto|.
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5961
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5962 *'spellfile'* *'spf'*
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5963 'spellfile' 'spf' string (default empty)
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5964 local to buffer
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5965 {not in Vi}
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5966 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5967 feature}
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5968 Name of the word list file where words are added for the |zg| and |zw|
401
4a1ead01d30b updated for version 7.0105
vimboss
parents: 389
diff changeset
5969 commands. It must end in ".{encoding}.add". You need to include the
4a1ead01d30b updated for version 7.0105
vimboss
parents: 389
diff changeset
5970 path, otherwise the file is placed in the current directory.
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5971 *E765*
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5972 It may also be a comma separated list of names. A count before the
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5973 |zg| and |zw| commands can be used to access each. This allows using
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
5974 a personal word list file and a project word list file.
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5975 When a word is added while this option is empty Vim will set it for
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
5976 you: Using the first directory in 'runtimepath' that is writable. If
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
5977 there is no "spell" directory yet it will be created. For the file
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
5978 name the first language name that appears in 'spelllang' is used,
353
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5979 ignoring the region.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5980 The resulting ".spl" file will be used for spell checking, it does not
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5981 have to appear in 'spelllang'.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5982 Normally one file is used for all regions, but you can add the region
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5983 name if you want to. However, it will then only be used when
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5984 'spellfile' is set to it, for entries in 'spelllang' only files
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5985 without region name will be found.
336
2d8c2622e1fa updated for version 7.0087
vimboss
parents: 314
diff changeset
5986 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2d8c2622e1fa updated for version 7.0087
vimboss
parents: 314
diff changeset
5987 security reasons.
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5988
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5989 *'spelllang'* *'spl'*
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
5990 'spelllang' 'spl' string (default "en")
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5991 local to buffer
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5992 {not in Vi}
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5993 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
5994 feature}
353
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5995 A comma separated list of word list names. When the 'spell' option is
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5996 on spellchecking will be done for these languages. Example: >
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5997 set spelllang=en_us,nl,medical
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5998 < This means US English, Dutch and medical words are recognized. Words
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
5999 that are not recognized will be highlighted.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6000 The word list name must not include a comma or dot. Using a dash is
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6001 recommended to separate the two letter language name from a
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6002 specification. Thus "en-rare" is used for rare English words.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6003 A region name must come last and have the form "_xx", where "xx" is
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6004 the two-letter, lower case region name. You can use more than one
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6005 region by listing them: "en_us,en_ca" supports both US and Canadian
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6006 English, but not words specific for Australia, New Zealand or Great
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6007 Britain.
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6008 *E757*
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6009 As a special case the name of a .spl file can be given as-is. The
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6010 first "_xx" in the name is removed and used as the region name
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6011 (_xx is an underscore, two letters and followed by a non-letter).
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6012 This is mainly for testing purposes. You must make sure the correct
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6013 encoding is used, Vim doesn't check it.
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
6014 When 'encoding' is set the word lists are reloaded. Thus it's a good
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6015 idea to set 'spelllang' after setting 'encoding' to avoid loading the
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6016 files twice.
353
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6017 How the related spell files are found is explained here: |spell-load|.
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6018
653
5acda076fb0c updated for version 7.0192
vimboss
parents: 650
diff changeset
6019 If the |spellfile.vim| plugin is active and you use a language name
5acda076fb0c updated for version 7.0192
vimboss
parents: 650
diff changeset
6020 for which Vim cannot find the .spl file in 'runtimepath' the plugin
5acda076fb0c updated for version 7.0192
vimboss
parents: 650
diff changeset
6021 will ask you if you want to download the file.
5acda076fb0c updated for version 7.0192
vimboss
parents: 650
diff changeset
6022
480
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6023 After this option has been set successfully, Vim will source the files
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6024 "spell/LANG.vim" in 'runtimepath'. "LANG" is the value of 'spelllang'
650
662e40bd2be1 updated for version 7.0191
vimboss
parents: 648
diff changeset
6025 up to the first comma, dot or underscore.
662e40bd2be1 updated for version 7.0191
vimboss
parents: 648
diff changeset
6026 Also see |set-spc-auto|.
480
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6027
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6028
344
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6029 *'spellsuggest'* *'sps'*
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6030 'spellsuggest' 'sps' string (default "best")
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6031 global
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6032 {not in Vi}
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6033 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6034 feature}
593
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
6035 Methods used for spelling suggestions. Both for the |z=| command and
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6036 the |spellsuggest()| function. This is a comma-separated list of
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6037 items:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6038
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6039 best Internal method that works best for English. Finds
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6040 changes like "fast" and uses a bit of sound-a-like
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6041 scoring to improve the ordering.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6042
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6043 double Internal method that uses two methods and mixes the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6044 results. The first method is "fast", the other method
344
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6045 computes how much the suggestion sounds like the bad
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6046 word. That only works when the language specifies
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6047 sound folding. Can be slow and doesn't always give
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6048 better results.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6049
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6050 fast Internal method that only checks for simple changes:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6051 character inserts/deletes/swaps. Works well for
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6052 simple typing mistakes.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6053
593
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
6054 {number} The maximum number of suggestions listed for |z=|.
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6055 Not used for |spellsuggest()|. The number of
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6056 suggestions is never more than the value of 'lines'
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6057 minus two.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6058
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6059 file:{filename} Read file {filename}, which must have two columns,
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6060 separated by a slash. The first column contains the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6061 bad word, the second column the suggested good word.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6062 Example:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6063 theribal/terrible ~
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6064 Use this for common mistakes that do not appear at the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6065 top of the suggestion list with the internal methods.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6066 Lines without a slash are ignored, use this for
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6067 comments.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6068 The file is used for all languages.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6069
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6070 expr:{expr} Evaluate expression {expr}. Use a function to avoid
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6071 trouble with spaces. |v:val| holds the badly spelled
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6072 word. The expression must evaluate to a List of
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6073 Lists, each with a suggestion and a score.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6074 Example:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6075 [['the', 33], ['that', 44]]
593
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
6076 Set 'verbose' and use |z=| to see the scores that the
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6077 internal methods use. A lower score is better.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6078 This may invoke |spellsuggest()| if you temporarily
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6079 set 'spellsuggest' to exclude the "expr:" part.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6080 Errors are silently ignored, unless you set the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6081 'verbose' option to a non-zero value.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6082
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6083 Only one of "best", "double" or "fast" may be used. The others may
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6084 appear several times in any order. Example: >
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6085 :set sps=file:~/.vim/sugg,best,expr:MySuggest()
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6086 <
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6087 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6088 security reasons.
344
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6089
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6090
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6091 *'splitbelow'* *'sb'* *'nosplitbelow'* *'nosb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6092 'splitbelow' 'sb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6093 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6094 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6095 {not available when compiled without the +windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6096 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6097 When on, splitting a window will put the new window below the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6098 one. |:split|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6099
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6100 *'splitright'* *'spr'* *'nosplitright'* *'nospr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6101 'splitright' 'spr' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6102 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6103 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6104 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6105 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6106 When on, splitting a window will put the new window right of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6107 current one. |:vsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6108
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6109 *'startofline'* *'sol'* *'nostartofline'* *'nosol'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6110 'startofline' 'sol' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6111 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6112 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6113 When "on" the commands listed below move the cursor to the first
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
6114 non-blank of the line. When off the cursor is kept in the same column
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6115 (if possible). This applies to the commands: CTRL-D, CTRL-U, CTRL-B,
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
6116 CTRL-F, "G", "H", "M", "L", gg, and to the commands "d", "<<" and ">>"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6117 with a linewise operator, with "%" with a count and to buffer changing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6118 commands (CTRL-^, :bnext, :bNext, etc.). Also for an Ex command that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6119 only has a line number, e.g., ":25" or ":+".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6120 In case of buffer changing commands the cursor is placed at the column
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6121 where it was the last time the buffer was edited.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6122 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6123
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6124 *'statusline'* *'stl'* *E540* *E541* *E542*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6125 'statusline' 'stl' string (default empty)
40
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
6126 global or local to window |global-local|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6127 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6128 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6129 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6130 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the status line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6131 Also see |status-line|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6132
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6133 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6134 normal text. Each status line item is of the form:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6135 %-0{minwid}.{maxwid}{item}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6136 All fields except the {item} is optional. A single percent sign can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6137 be given as "%%". Up to 80 items can be specified.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6138
680
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6139 When the option starts with "%!" then it is used as an expression,
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6140 evaluated and the result is used as the option value. Example: >
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6141 :set statusline=%!MyStatusLine()
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6142 < The result can contain %{} items that will be evaluated too.
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6143
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6144 When there is error while evaluating the option then it will be made
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6145 empty to avoid further errors. Otherwise screen updating would loop.
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6146
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6147 Note that the only effect of 'ruler' when this option is set (and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6148 'laststatus' is 2) is controlling the output of |CTRL-G|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6149
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6150 field meaning ~
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6151 - Left justify the item. The default is right justified
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6152 when minwid is larger than the length of the item.
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6153 0 Leading zeroes in numeric items. Overridden by '-'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6154 minwid Minimum width of the item, padding as set by '-' & '0'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6155 Value must be 50 or less.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6156 maxwid Maximum width of the item. Truncation occurs with a '<'
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6157 on the left for text items. Numeric items will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6158 shifted down to maxwid-2 digits followed by '>'number
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6159 where number is the amount of missing digits, much like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6160 an exponential notation.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6161 item A one letter code as described below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6162
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6163 Following is a description of the possible statusline items. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6164 second character in "item" is the type:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6165 N for number
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6166 S for string
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6167 F for flags as described below
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6168 - not applicable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6169
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6170 item meaning ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6171 f S Path to the file in the buffer, relative to current directory.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6172 F S Full path to the file in the buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6173 t S File name (tail) of file in the buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6174 m F Modified flag, text is " [+]"; " [-]" if 'modifiable' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6175 M F Modified flag, text is ",+" or ",-".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6176 r F Readonly flag, text is " [RO]".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6177 R F Readonly flag, text is ",RO".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6178 h F Help buffer flag, text is " [help]".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6179 H F Help buffer flag, text is ",HLP".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6180 w F Preview window flag, text is " [Preview]".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6181 W F Preview window flag, text is ",PRV".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6182 y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., " [vim]". See 'filetype'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6183 Y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., ",VIM". See 'filetype'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6184 {not available when compiled without |+autocmd| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6185 k S Value of "b:keymap_name" or 'keymap' when |:lmap| mappings are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6186 being used: "<keymap>"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6187 n N Buffer number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6188 b N Value of byte under cursor.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6189 B N As above, in hexadecimal.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6190 o N Byte number in file of byte under cursor, first byte is 1.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6191 Mnemonic: Offset from start of file (with one added)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6192 {not available when compiled without |+byte_offset| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6193 O N As above, in hexadecimal.
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6194 N N Printer page number. (Only works in the 'printheader' option.)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6195 l N Line number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6196 L N Number of lines in buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6197 c N Column number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6198 v N Virtual column number.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6199 V N Virtual column number as -{num}. Not displayed if equal to 'c'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6200 p N Percentage through file in lines as in |CTRL-G|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6201 P S Percentage through file of displayed window. This is like the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6202 percentage described for 'ruler'. Always 3 in length.
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6203 a S Argument list status as in default title. ({current} of {max})
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6204 Empty if the argument file count is zero or one.
680
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6205 { NF Evaluate expression between '%{' and '}' and substitute result.
625
81fe2ccc1207 updated for version 7.0179
vimboss
parents: 623
diff changeset
6206 Note that there is no '%' before the closing '}'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6207 ( - Start of item group. Can be used for setting the width and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6208 alignment of a section. Must be followed by %) somewhere.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6209 ) - End of item group. No width fields allowed.
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6210 T N For 'tabline': start of tab page N label. Use %T after the last
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6211 label. This information is used for mouse clicks.
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6212 X N For 'tabline': start of close tab N label. Use %X after the
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6213 label, e.g.: %3Xclose%X. Use %999X for a "close current tab"
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6214 mark. This information is used for mouse clicks.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6215 < - Where to truncate line if too long. Default is at the start.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6216 No width fields allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6217 = - Separation point between left and right aligned items.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6218 No width fields allowed.
680
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6219 # - Set highlight group. The name must follow and then a # again.
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6220 Thus use %#HLname# for highlight group HLname. The same
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6221 highlighting is used, also for the statusline of non-current
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6222 windows.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6223 * - Set highlight group to User{N}, where {N} is taken from the
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6224 minwid field, e.g. %1*. Restore normal highlight with %* or %0*.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6225 The difference between User{N} and StatusLine will be applied
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6226 to StatusLineNC for the statusline of non-current windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6227 The number N must be between 1 and 9. See |hl-User1..9|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6228
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6229 Display of flags are controlled by the following heuristic:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6230 If a flag text starts with comma it is assumed that it wants to
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6231 separate itself from anything but preceding plaintext. If it starts
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6232 with a space it is assumed that it wants to separate itself from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6233 anything but other flags. That is: A leading comma is removed if the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6234 preceding character stems from plaintext. A leading space is removed
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6235 if the preceding character stems from another active flag. This will
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6236 make a nice display when flags are used like in the examples below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6237
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6238 When all items in a group becomes an empty string (i.e. flags that are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6239 not set) and a minwid is not set for the group, the whole group will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6240 become empty. This will make a group like the following disappear
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6241 completely from the statusline when none of the flags are set. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6242 :set statusline=...%(\ [%M%R%H]%)...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6243 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6244 Beware that an expression is evaluated each and every time the status
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6245 line is displayed. The current buffer and current window will be set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6246 temporarily to that of the window (and buffer) whose statusline is
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6247 currently being drawn. The expression will evaluate in this context.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6248 The variable "actual_curbuf" is set to the 'bufnr()' number of the
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6249 real current buffer.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6250
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6251 The 'statusline' option may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6252 |sandbox-option|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6253
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6254 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6255 evaluating 'statusline' |textlock|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6256
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6257 If the statusline is not updated when you want it (e.g., after setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6258 a variable that's used in an expression), you can force an update by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6259 setting an option without changing its value. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6260 :let &ro = &ro
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6261
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6262 < A result of all digits is regarded a number for display purposes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6263 Otherwise the result is taken as flag text and applied to the rules
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6264 described above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6265
199
3b32f6b507fa updated for version 7.0059
vimboss
parents: 189
diff changeset
6266 Watch out for errors in expressions. They may render Vim unusable!
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6267 If you are stuck, hold down ':' or 'Q' to get a prompt, then quit and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6268 edit your .vimrc or whatever with "vim -u NONE" to get it right.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6269
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6270 Examples:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6271 Emulate standard status line with 'ruler' set >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6272 :set statusline=%<%f\ %h%m%r%=%-14.(%l,%c%V%)\ %P
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6273 < Similar, but add ASCII value of char under the cursor (like "ga") >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6274 :set statusline=%<%f%h%m%r%=%b\ 0x%B\ \ %l,%c%V\ %P
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6275 < Display byte count and byte value, modified flag in red. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6276 :set statusline=%<%f%=\ [%1*%M%*%n%R%H]\ %-19(%3l,%02c%03V%)%O'%02b'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6277 :hi User1 term=inverse,bold cterm=inverse,bold ctermfg=red
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6278 < Display a ,GZ flag if a compressed file is loaded >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6279 :set statusline=...%r%{VarExists('b:gzflag','\ [GZ]')}%h...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6280 < In the |:autocmd|'s: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6281 :let b:gzflag = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6282 < And: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6283 :unlet b:gzflag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6284 < And define this function: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6285 :function VarExists(var, val)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6286 : if exists(a:var) | return a:val | else | return '' | endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6287 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6288 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6289 *'suffixes'* *'su'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6290 'suffixes' 'su' string (default ".bak,~,.o,.h,.info,.swp,.obj")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6291 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6292 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6293 Files with these suffixes get a lower priority when multiple files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6294 match a wildcard. See |suffixes|. Commas can be used to separate the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6295 suffixes. Spaces after the comma are ignored. A dot is also seen as
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6296 the start of a suffix. To avoid a dot or comma being recognized as a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6297 separator, precede it with a backslash (see |option-backslash| about
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6298 including spaces and backslashes).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6299 See 'wildignore' for completely ignoring files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6300 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6301 suffixes from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6302 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6303
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6304 *'suffixesadd'* *'sua'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6305 'suffixesadd' 'sua' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6306 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6307 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6308 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6309 |+file_in_path| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6310 Comma separated list of suffixes, which are used when searching for a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6311 file for the "gf", "[I", etc. commands. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6312 :set suffixesadd=.java
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6313 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6314 *'swapfile'* *'swf'* *'noswapfile'* *'noswf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6315 'swapfile' 'swf' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6316 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6317 {not in Vi}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6318 Use a swapfile for the buffer. This option can be reset when a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6319 swapfile is not wanted for a specific buffer. For example, with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6320 confidential information that even root must not be able to access.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6321 Careful: All text will be in memory:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6322 - Don't use this for big files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6323 - Recovery will be impossible!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6324 A swapfile will only be present when |'updatecount'| is non-zero and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6325 'swapfile' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6326 When 'swapfile' is reset, the swap file for the current buffer is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6327 immediately deleted. When 'swapfile' is set, and 'updatecount' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6328 non-zero, a swap file is immediately created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6329 Also see |swap-file| and |'swapsync'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6330
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6331 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'buftype' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6332 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6333
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6334 *'swapsync'* *'sws'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6335 'swapsync' 'sws' string (default "fsync")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6336 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6337 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6338 When this option is not empty a swap file is synced to disk after
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6339 writing to it. This takes some time, especially on busy unix systems.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6340 When this option is empty parts of the swap file may be in memory and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6341 not written to disk. When the system crashes you may lose more work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6342 On Unix the system does a sync now and then without Vim asking for it,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6343 so the disadvantage of setting this option off is small. On some
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6344 systems the swap file will not be written at all. For a unix system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6345 setting it to "sync" will use the sync() call instead of the default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6346 fsync(), which may work better on some systems.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
6347 The 'fsync' option is used for the actual file.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6348
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6349 *'switchbuf'* *'swb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6350 'switchbuf' 'swb' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6351 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6352 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6353 This option controls the behavior when switching between buffers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6354 Possible values (comma separated list):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6355 useopen If included, jump to the first open window that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6356 contains the specified buffer (if there is one).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6357 Otherwise: Do not examine other windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6358 This setting is checked with |quickfix| commands, when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6359 jumping to errors (":cc", ":cn", "cp", etc.). It is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6360 also used in all buffer related split commands, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6361 example ":sbuffer", ":sbnext", or ":sbrewind".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6362 split If included, split the current window before loading
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6363 a buffer. Otherwise: do not split, use current window.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6364 Supported in |quickfix| commands that display errors.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6365
410
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6366 *'synmaxcol'* *'smc'*
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6367 'synmaxcol' 'smc' number (default 3000)
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6368 local to buffer
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6369 {not in Vi}
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6370 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6371 feature}
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6372 Maximum column in which to search for syntax items. In long lines the
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6373 text after this column is not highlighted and following lines may not
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6374 be highlighted correctly, because the syntax state is cleared.
410
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6375 This helps to avoid very slow redrawing for an XML file that is one
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6376 long line.
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6377 Set to zero to remove the limit.
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6378
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6379 *'syntax'* *'syn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6380 'syntax' 'syn' string (default empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6381 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6382 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6383 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6384 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6385 When this option is set, the syntax with this name is loaded, unless
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6386 syntax highlighting has been switched off with ":syntax off".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6387 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current syntax (the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6388 b:current_syntax variable does).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6389 This option is most useful in a modeline, for a file which syntax is
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6390 not automatically recognized. Example, in an IDL file:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6391 /* vim: set syntax=idl : */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6392 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6393 names. Example:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6394 /* vim: set syntax=c.doxygen : */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6395 This will use the "c" syntax first, then the "doxygen" syntax.
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6396 Note that the second one must be prepared to be loaded as an addition,
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6397 otherwise it will be skipped. More than one dot may appear.
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6398 To switch off syntax highlighting for the current file, use: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6399 :set syntax=OFF
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6400 < To switch syntax highlighting on according to the current value of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6401 'filetype' option: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6402 :set syntax=ON
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6403 < What actually happens when setting the 'syntax' option is that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6404 Syntax autocommand event is triggered with the value as argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6405 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6406 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
6407 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6408
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6409 *'tabline'* *'tal'*
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6410 'tabline' 'tal' string (default empty)
674
4b8583e82cb8 updated for version 7.0201
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
6411 global
4b8583e82cb8 updated for version 7.0201
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
6412 {not in Vi}
4b8583e82cb8 updated for version 7.0201
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
6413 {not available when compiled without the +windows
4b8583e82cb8 updated for version 7.0201
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
6414 feature}
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6415 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the tab pages
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6416 line at the top of the Vim window. When empty Vim will use a default
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6417 tab pages line. See |setting-tabline| for more info.
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6418
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6419 The tab pages line only appears as specified with the 'showtabline'
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
6420 option and only when there is no GUI tab line. When 'e' is in
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
6421 'guioptions' and the GUI supports a tab line 'guitablabel' is used
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
6422 instead.
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6423
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6424 The value is evaluated like with 'statusline'. You can use
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6425 |tabpagenr()|, |tabpagewinnr()| and |tabpagebuflist()| to figure out
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6426 the text to be displayed. Use "%1T" for the first label, "%2T" for
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6427 the second one, etc. Use "%X" items for closing labels.
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6428
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6429 Keep in mind that only one of the tab pages is the current one, others
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6430 are invisible and you can't jump to their windows.
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6431
674
4b8583e82cb8 updated for version 7.0201
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
6432
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6433 *'tabpagemax'* *'tpm'*
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6434 'tabpagemax' 'tpm' number (default 10)
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6435 global
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6436 {not in Vi}
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6437 {not available when compiled without the +windows
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6438 feature}
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6439 Maximum number of tab pages to be opened by the |-p| command line
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6440 argument or the ":tab all" command. |tabpage|
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6441
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6442
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6443 *'tabstop'* *'ts'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6444 'tabstop' 'ts' number (default 8)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6445 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6446 Number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for. Also see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6447 |:retab| command, and 'softtabstop' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6448
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6449 Note: Setting 'tabstop' to any other value than 8 can make your file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6450 appear wrong in many places (e.g., when printing it).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6451
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6452 There are four main ways to use tabs in Vim:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6453 1. Always keep 'tabstop' at 8, set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to 4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6454 (or 3 or whatever you prefer) and use 'noexpandtab'. Then Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6455 will use a mix of tabs and spaces, but typing Tab and BS will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6456 behave like a tab appears every 4 (or 3) characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6457 2. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6458 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6459 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6460 3. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use a
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6461 |modeline| to set these values when editing the file again. Only
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6462 works when using Vim to edit the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6463 4. Always set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to the same value, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6464 'noexpandtab'. This should then work (for initial indents only)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6465 for any tabstop setting that people use. It might be nice to have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6466 tabs after the first non-blank inserted as spaces if you do this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6467 though. Otherwise aligned comments will be wrong when 'tabstop' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6468 changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6469
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6470 *'tagbsearch'* *'tbs'* *'notagbsearch'* *'notbs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6471 'tagbsearch' 'tbs' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6472 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6473 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6474 When searching for a tag (e.g., for the |:ta| command), Vim can either
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6475 use a binary search or a linear search in a tags file. Binary
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6476 searching makes searching for a tag a LOT faster, but a linear search
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6477 will find more tags if the tags file wasn't properly sorted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6478 Vim normally assumes that your tags files are sorted, or indicate that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6479 they are not sorted. Only when this is not the case does the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6480 'tagbsearch' option need to be switched off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6481
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6482 When 'tagbsearch' is on, binary searching is first used in the tags
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6483 files. In certain situations, Vim will do a linear search instead for
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6484 certain files, or retry all files with a linear search. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6485 'tagbsearch' is off, only a linear search is done.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6486
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6487 Linear searching is done anyway, for one file, when Vim finds a line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6488 at the start of the file indicating that it's not sorted: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6489 !_TAG_FILE_SORTED 0 /some command/
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6490 < [The whitespace before and after the '0' must be a single <Tab>]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6491
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6492 When a binary search was done and no match was found in any of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6493 files listed in 'tags', and 'ignorecase' is set or a pattern is used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6494 instead of a normal tag name, a retry is done with a linear search.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6495 Tags in unsorted tags files, and matches with different case will only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6496 be found in the retry.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6497
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 20
diff changeset
6498 If a tag file indicates that it is case-fold sorted, the second,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6499 linear search can be avoided for the 'ignorecase' case. Use a value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6500 of '2' in the "!_TAG_FILE_SORTED" line for this. A tag file can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6501 case-fold sorted with the -f switch to "sort" in most unices, as in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6502 the command: "sort -f -o tags tags". For "Exuberant ctags" version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6503 5.3 or higher the -f or --fold-case-sort switch can be used for this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6504 as well. Note that case must be folded to uppercase for this to work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6505
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6506 When 'tagbsearch' is off, tags searching is slower when a full match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6507 exists, but faster when no full match exists. Tags in unsorted tags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6508 files may only be found with 'tagbsearch' off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6509 When the tags file is not sorted, or sorted in a wrong way (not on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6510 ASCII byte value), 'tagbsearch' should be off, or the line given above
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6511 must be included in the tags file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6512 This option doesn't affect commands that find all matching tags (e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6513 command-line completion and ":help").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6514 {Vi: always uses binary search in some versions}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6515
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6516 *'taglength'* *'tl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6517 'taglength' 'tl' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6518 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6519 If non-zero, tags are significant up to this number of characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6520
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6521 *'tagrelative'* *'tr'* *'notagrelative'* *'notr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6522 'tagrelative' 'tr' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6523 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6524 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6525 If on and using a tag file in another directory, file names in that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6526 tag file are relative to the directory where the tag file is.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6527 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6528 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6529
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6530 *'tags'* *'tag'* *E433*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6531 'tags' 'tag' string (default "./tags,tags", when compiled with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6532 |+emacs_tags|: "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6533 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6534 Filenames for the tag command, separated by spaces or commas. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6535 include a space or comma in a file name, precede it with a backslash
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6536 (see |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6537 When a file name starts with "./", the '.' is replaced with the path
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6538 of the current file. But only when the 'd' flag is not included in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6539 'cpoptions'. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. Also see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6540 |tags-option|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6541 "*", "**" and other wildcards can be used to search for tags files in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6542 a directory tree. See |file-searching|. {not available when compiled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6543 without the |+path_extra| feature}
515
04dcb5a1f2f9 updated for version 7.0144
vimboss
parents: 502
diff changeset
6544 The |tagfiles()| function can be used to get a list of the file names
04dcb5a1f2f9 updated for version 7.0144
vimboss
parents: 502
diff changeset
6545 actually used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6546 If Vim was compiled with the |+emacs_tags| feature, Emacs-style tag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6547 files are also supported. They are automatically recognized. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6548 default value becomes "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS", unless case
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6549 differences are ignored (MS-Windows). |emacs-tags|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6550 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6551 file names from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6552 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6553 {Vi: default is "tags /usr/lib/tags"}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6554
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6555 *'tagstack'* *'tgst'* *'notagstack'* *'notgst'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6556 'tagstack' 'tgst' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6557 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6558 {not in all versions of Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6559 When on, the |tagstack| is used normally. When off, a ":tag" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6560 ":tselect" command with an argument will not push the tag onto the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6561 tagstack. A following ":tag" without an argument, a ":pop" command or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6562 any other command that uses the tagstack will use the unmodified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6563 tagstack, but does change the pointer to the active entry.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6564 Resetting this option is useful when using a ":tag" command in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6565 mapping which should not change the tagstack.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6566
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6567 *'term'* *E529* *E530* *E531*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6568 'term' string (default is $TERM, if that fails:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6569 in the GUI: "builtin_gui"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6570 on Amiga: "amiga"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6571 on BeOS: "beos-ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6572 on Mac: "mac-ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6573 on MiNT: "vt52"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6574 on MS-DOS: "pcterm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6575 on OS/2: "os2ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6576 on Unix: "ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6577 on VMS: "ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6578 on Win 32: "win32")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6579 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6580 Name of the terminal. Used for choosing the terminal control
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6581 characters. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6582 For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6583 :set term=$TERM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6584 < See |termcap|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6585
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6586 *'termbidi'* *'tbidi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6587 *'notermbidi'* *'notbidi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6588 'termbidi' 'tbidi' boolean (default off, on for "mlterm")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6589 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6590 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6591 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6592 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6593 The terminal is in charge of Bi-directionality of text (as specified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6594 by Unicode). The terminal is also expected to do the required shaping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6595 that some languages (such as Arabic) require.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6596 Setting this option implies that 'rightleft' will not be set when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6597 'arabic' is set and the value of 'arabicshape' will be ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6598 Note that setting 'termbidi' has the immediate effect that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6599 'arabicshape' is ignored, but 'rightleft' isn't changed automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6600 This option is reset when the GUI is started.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6601 For further details see |arabic.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6602
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6603 *'termencoding'* *'tenc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6604 'termencoding' 'tenc' string (default ""; with GTK+ 2 GUI: "utf-8"; with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6605 Macintosh GUI: "macroman")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6606 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6607 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6608 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6609 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6610 Encoding used for the terminal. This specifies what character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6611 encoding the keyboard produces and the display will understand. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6612 the GUI it only applies to the keyboard ('encoding' is used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6613 display).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6614 In the Win32 console version the default value is the console codepage
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6615 when it differs from the ANSI codepage.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6616 *E617*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6617 Note: This does not apply to the GTK+ 2 GUI. After the GUI has been
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6618 successfully initialized, 'termencoding' is forcibly set to "utf-8".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6619 Any attempts to set a different value will be rejected, and an error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6620 message is shown.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6621 For the Win32 GUI 'termencoding' is not used for typed characters,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6622 because the Win32 system always passes Unicode characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6623 When empty, the same encoding is used as for the 'encoding' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6624 This is the normal value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6625 Not all combinations for 'termencoding' and 'encoding' are valid. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6626 |encoding-table|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6627 The value for this option must be supported by internal conversions or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6628 iconv(). When this is not possible no conversion will be done and you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6629 will probably experience problems with non-ASCII characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6630 Example: You are working with the locale set to euc-jp (Japanese) and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6631 want to edit a UTF-8 file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6632 :let &termencoding = &encoding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6633 :set encoding=utf-8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6634 < You need to do this when your system has no locale support for UTF-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6635
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6636 *'terse'* *'noterse'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6637 'terse' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6638 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6639 When set: Add 's' flag to 'shortmess' option (this makes the message
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6640 for a search that hits the start or end of the file not being
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6641 displayed). When reset: Remove 's' flag from 'shortmess' option. {Vi
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6642 shortens a lot of messages}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6643
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6644 *'textauto'* *'ta'* *'notextauto'* *'nota'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6645 'textauto' 'ta' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6646 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6647 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6648 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformats'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6649 For backwards compatibility, when 'textauto' is set, 'fileformats' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6650 set to the default value for the current system. When 'textauto' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6651 reset, 'fileformats' is made empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6652 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6653 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6654
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6655 *'textmode'* *'tx'* *'notextmode'* *'notx'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6656 'textmode' 'tx' boolean (MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: default on,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6657 others: default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6658 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6659 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6660 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformat'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6661 For backwards compatibility, when 'textmode' is set, 'fileformat' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6662 set to "dos". When 'textmode' is reset, 'fileformat' is set to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6663 "unix".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6664
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6665 *'textwidth'* *'tw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6666 'textwidth' 'tw' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6667 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6668 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6669 Maximum width of text that is being inserted. A longer line will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6670 broken after white space to get this width. A zero value disables
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6671 this. 'textwidth' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set. When
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6672 'textwidth' is zero, 'wrapmargin' may be used. See also
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6673 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6674 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6675
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6676 *'thesaurus'* *'tsr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6677 'thesaurus' 'tsr' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6678 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6679 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6680 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6681 for thesaurus completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. Each line in
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6682 the file should contain words with similar meaning, separated by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6683 non-keyword characters (white space is preferred). Maximum line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6684 length is 510 bytes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6685 To obtain a file to be used here, check out the wordlist FAQ at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6686 http://www.hyphenologist.co.uk .
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6687 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6688 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6689 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6690 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6691 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6692 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6693 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6694
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6695 *'tildeop'* *'top'* *'notildeop'* *'notop'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6696 'tildeop' 'top' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6697 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6698 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6699 When on: The tilde command "~" behaves like an operator.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6700 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6701
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6702 *'timeout'* *'to'* *'notimeout'* *'noto'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6703 'timeout' 'to' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6704 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6705 *'ttimeout'* *'nottimeout'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6706 'ttimeout' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6707 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6708 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6709 These two options together determine the behavior when part of a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6710 mapped key sequence or keyboard code has been received:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6711
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6712 'timeout' 'ttimeout' action ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6713 off off do not time out
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6714 on on or off time out on :mappings and key codes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6715 off on time out on key codes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6716
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6717 If both options are off, Vim will wait until either the complete
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6718 mapping or key sequence has been received, or it is clear that there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6719 is no mapping or key sequence for the received characters. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6720 example: if you have mapped "vl" and Vim has received 'v', the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6721 character is needed to see if the 'v' is followed by an 'l'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6722 When one of the options is on, Vim will wait for about 1 second for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6723 the next character to arrive. After that the already received
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6724 characters are interpreted as single characters. The waiting time can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6725 be changed with the 'timeoutlen' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6726 On slow terminals or very busy systems timing out may cause
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6727 malfunctioning cursor keys. If both options are off, Vim waits
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6728 forever after an entered <Esc> if there are key codes that start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6729 with <Esc>. You will have to type <Esc> twice. If you do not have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6730 problems with key codes, but would like to have :mapped key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6731 sequences not timing out in 1 second, set the 'ttimeout' option and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6732 reset the 'timeout' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6733
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6734 NOTE: 'ttimeout' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6735
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6736 *'timeoutlen'* *'tm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6737 'timeoutlen' 'tm' number (default 1000)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6738 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6739 {not in all versions of Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6740 *'ttimeoutlen'* *'ttm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6741 'ttimeoutlen' 'ttm' number (default -1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6742 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6743 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6744 The time in milliseconds that is waited for a key code or mapped key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6745 sequence to complete. Also used for CTRL-\ CTRL-N and CTRL-\ CTRL-G
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6746 when part of a command has been typed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6747 Normally only 'timeoutlen' is used and 'ttimeoutlen' is -1. When a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6748 different timeout value for key codes is desired set 'ttimeoutlen' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6749 a non-negative number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6750
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6751 ttimeoutlen mapping delay key code delay ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6752 < 0 'timeoutlen' 'timeoutlen'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6753 >= 0 'timeoutlen' 'ttimeoutlen'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6754
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6755 The timeout only happens when the 'timeout' and 'ttimeout' options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6756 tell so. A useful setting would be >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6757 :set timeout timeoutlen=3000 ttimeoutlen=100
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6758 < (time out on mapping after three seconds, time out on key codes after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6759 a tenth of a second).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6760
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6761 *'title'* *'notitle'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6762 'title' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6763 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6764 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6765 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6766 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6767 When on, the title of the window will be set to the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6768 'titlestring' (if it is not empty), or to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6769 filename [+=-] (path) - VIM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6770 Where:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6771 filename the name of the file being edited
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6772 - indicates the file cannot be modified, 'ma' off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6773 + indicates the file was modified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6774 = indicates the file is read-only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6775 =+ indicates the file is read-only and modified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6776 (path) is the path of the file being edited
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6777 - VIM the server name |v:servername| or "VIM"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6778 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6779 (currently Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6780 terminals with a non- empty 't_ts' option - these are Unix xterm and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6781 iris-ansi by default, where 't_ts' is taken from the builtin termcap).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6782 *X11*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6783 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6784 be restored if possible. The output of ":version" will include "+X11"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6785 when HAVE_X11 was defined, otherwise it will be "-X11". This also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6786 works for the icon name |'icon'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6787 But: When Vim was started with the |-X| argument, restoring the title
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6788 will not work (except in the GUI).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6789 If the title cannot be restored, it is set to the value of 'titleold'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6790 You might want to restore the title outside of Vim then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6791 When using an xterm from a remote machine you can use this command:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6792 rsh machine_name xterm -display $DISPLAY &
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6793 then the WINDOWID environment variable should be inherited and the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6794 title of the window should change back to what it should be after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6795 exiting Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6796
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6797 *'titlelen'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6798 'titlelen' number (default 85)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6799 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6800 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6801 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6802 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6803 Gives the percentage of 'columns' to use for the length of the window
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6804 title. When the title is longer, only the end of the path name is
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6805 shown. A '<' character before the path name is used to indicate this.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6806 Using a percentage makes this adapt to the width of the window. But
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6807 it won't work perfectly, because the actual number of characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6808 available also depends on the font used and other things in the title
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6809 bar. When 'titlelen' is zero the full path is used. Otherwise,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6810 values from 1 to 30000 percent can be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6811 'titlelen' is also used for the 'titlestring' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6812
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6813 *'titleold'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6814 'titleold' string (default "Thanks for flying Vim")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6815 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6816 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6817 {only available when compiled with the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6818 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6819 This option will be used for the window title when exiting Vim if the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6820 original title cannot be restored. Only happens if 'title' is on or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6821 'titlestring' is not empty.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
6822 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
6823 security reasons.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6824 *'titlestring'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6825 'titlestring' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6826 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6827 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6828 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6829 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6830 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the title of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6831 window. This happens only when the 'title' option is on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6832 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles (currently
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6833 Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and terminals with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6834 non-empty 't_ts' option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6835 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6836 be restored if possible |X11|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6837 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6838 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6839 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6840 :auto BufEnter * let &titlestring = hostname() . "/" . expand("%:p")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6841 :set title titlestring=%<%F%=%l/%L-%P titlelen=70
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6842 < The value of 'titlelen' is used to align items in the middle or right
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6843 of the available space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6844 Some people prefer to have the file name first: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6845 :set titlestring=%t%(\ %M%)%(\ (%{expand(\"%:~:.:h\")})%)%(\ %a%)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6846 < Note the use of "%{ }" and an expression to get the path of the file,
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6847 without the file name. The "%( %)" constructs are used to add a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6848 separating space only when needed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6849 NOTE: Use of special characters in 'titlestring' may cause the display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6850 to be garbled (e.g., when it contains a CR or NL character).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6851 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6852
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6853 *'toolbar'* *'tb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6854 'toolbar' 'tb' string (default "icons,tooltips")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6855 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6856 {only for |+GUI_GTK|, |+GUI_Athena|, |+GUI_Motif| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6857 |+GUI_Photon|}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6858 The contents of this option controls various toolbar settings. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6859 possible values are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6860 icons Toolbar buttons are shown with icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6861 text Toolbar buttons shown with text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6862 horiz Icon and text of a toolbar button are
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6863 horizontally arranged. {only in GTK+ 2 GUI}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6864 tooltips Tooltips are active for toolbar buttons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6865 Tooltips refer to the popup help text which appears after the mouse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6866 cursor is placed over a toolbar button for a brief moment.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6867
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6868 If you want the toolbar to be shown with icons as well as text, do the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6869 following: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6870 :set tb=icons,text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6871 < Motif and Athena cannot display icons and text at the same time. They
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6872 will show icons if both are requested.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6873
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6874 If none of the strings specified in 'toolbar' are valid or if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6875 'toolbar' is empty, this option is ignored. If you want to disable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6876 the toolbar, you need to set the 'guioptions' option. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6877 :set guioptions-=T
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6878 < Also see |gui-toolbar|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6879
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6880 *'toolbariconsize'* *'tbis'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6881 'toolbariconsize' 'tbis' string (default "small")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6882 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6883 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6884 {only in the GTK+ 2 GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6885 Controls the size of toolbar icons. The possible values are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6886 tiny Use tiny toolbar icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6887 small Use small toolbar icons (default).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6888 medium Use medium-sized toolbar icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6889 large Use large toolbar icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6890 The exact dimensions in pixels of the various icon sizes depend on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6891 the current theme. Common dimensions are large=32x32, medium=24x24,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6892 small=20x20 and tiny=16x16.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6893
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6894 If 'toolbariconsize' is empty, the global default size as determined
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6895 by user preferences or the current theme is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6896
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6897 *'ttybuiltin'* *'tbi'* *'nottybuiltin'* *'notbi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6898 'ttybuiltin' 'tbi' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6899 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6900 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6901 When on, the builtin termcaps are searched before the external ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6902 When off the builtin termcaps are searched after the external ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6903 When this option is changed, you should set the 'term' option next for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6904 the change to take effect, for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6905 :set notbi term=$TERM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6906 < See also |termcap|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6907 Rationale: The default for this option is "on", because the builtin
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6908 termcap entries are generally better (many systems contain faulty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6909 xterm entries...).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6910
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6911 *'ttyfast'* *'tf'* *'nottyfast'* *'notf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6912 'ttyfast' 'tf' boolean (default off, on when 'term' is xterm, hpterm,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6913 sun-cmd, screen, rxvt, dtterm or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6914 iris-ansi; also on when running Vim in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6915 a DOS console)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6916 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6917 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6918 Indicates a fast terminal connection. More characters will be sent to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6919 the screen for redrawing, instead of using insert/delete line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6920 commands. Improves smoothness of redrawing when there are multiple
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6921 windows and the terminal does not support a scrolling region.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6922 Also enables the extra writing of characters at the end of each screen
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6923 line for lines that wrap. This helps when using copy/paste with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6924 mouse in an xterm and other terminals.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6925
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6926 *'ttymouse'* *'ttym'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6927 'ttymouse' 'ttym' string (default depends on 'term')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6928 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6929 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6930 {only in Unix and VMS, doesn't work in the GUI; not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6931 available when compiled without |+mouse|}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6932 Name of the terminal type for which mouse codes are to be recognized.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6933 Currently these three strings are valid:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6934 *xterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6935 xterm xterm-like mouse handling. The mouse generates
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6936 "<Esc>[Mscr", where "scr" is three bytes:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6937 "s" = button state
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6938 "c" = column plus 33
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6939 "r" = row plus 33
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
6940 This only works up to 223 columns! See "dec" for a
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
6941 solution.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6942 xterm2 Works like "xterm", but with the xterm reporting the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6943 mouse position while the mouse is dragged. This works
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6944 much faster and more precise. Your xterm must at
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
6945 least at patchlevel 88 / XFree 3.3.3 for this to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6946 work. See below for how Vim detects this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6947 automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6948 *netterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6949 netterm NetTerm mouse handling. The mouse generates
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6950 "<Esc>}r,c<CR>", where "r,c" are two decimal numbers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6951 for the row and column.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6952 *dec-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6953 dec DEC terminal mouse handling. The mouse generates a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6954 rather complex sequence, starting with "<Esc>[".
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
6955 This is also available for an Xterm, if it was
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
6956 configured with "--enable-dec-locator".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6957 *jsbterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6958 jsbterm JSB term mouse handling.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6959 *pterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6960 pterm QNX pterm mouse handling.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6961
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6962 The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6963 |+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6964 Only "xterm"(2) is really recognized. NetTerm mouse codes are always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6965 recognized, if enabled at compile time. DEC terminal mouse codes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6966 are recognized if enabled at compile time, and 'ttymouse' is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6967 "xterm" (because the xterm and dec mouse codes conflict).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6968 This option is automatically set to "xterm", when the 'term' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6969 set to a name that starts with "xterm", and 'ttymouse' is not "xterm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6970 or "xterm2" already. The main use of this option is to set it to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6971 "xterm", when the terminal name doesn't start with "xterm", but it can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6972 handle xterm mouse codes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6973 The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6974 95 of higher. This only works when compiled with the |+termresponse|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6975 feature and if |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6976 xterm version number. Otherwise "xterm2" must be set explicitly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6977 If you do not want 'ttymouse' to be set to "xterm2" automatically, set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6978 t_RV to an empty string: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6979 :set t_RV=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6980 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6981 *'ttyscroll'* *'tsl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6982 'ttyscroll' 'tsl' number (default 999)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6983 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6984 Maximum number of lines to scroll the screen. If there are more lines
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6985 to scroll the window is redrawn. For terminals where scrolling is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6986 very slow and redrawing is not slow this can be set to a small number,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6987 e.g., 3, to speed up displaying.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6988
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6989 *'ttytype'* *'tty'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6990 'ttytype' 'tty' string (default from $TERM)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6991 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6992 Alias for 'term', see above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6993
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6994 *'undolevels'* *'ul'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6995 'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6996 Win32 and OS/2)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6997 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6998 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6999 Maximum number of changes that can be undone. Since undo information
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7000 is kept in memory, higher numbers will cause more memory to be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7001 (nevertheless, a single change can use an unlimited amount of memory).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7002 Set to 0 for Vi compatibility: One level of undo and "u" undoes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7003 itself: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7004 set ul=0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7005 < But you can also get Vi compatibility by including the 'u' flag in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7006 'cpoptions', and still be able to use CTRL-R to repeat undo.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7007 Set to a negative number for no undo at all: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7008 set ul=-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7009 < This helps when you run out of memory for a single change.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7010 Also see |undo-two-ways|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7011
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7012 *'updatecount'* *'uc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7013 'updatecount' 'uc' number (default: 200)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7014 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7015 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7016 After typing this many characters the swap file will be written to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7017 disk. When zero, no swap file will be created at all (see chapter on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7018 recovery |crash-recovery|). 'updatecount' is set to zero by starting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7019 Vim with the "-n" option, see |startup|. When editing in readonly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7020 mode this option will be initialized to 10000.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7021 The swapfile can be disabled per buffer with |'swapfile'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7022 When 'updatecount' is set from zero to non-zero, swap files are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7023 created for all buffers that have 'swapfile' set. When 'updatecount'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7024 is set to zero, existing swap files are not deleted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7025 Also see |'swapsync'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7026 This option has no meaning in buffers where |'buftype'| is "nofile"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7027 or "nowrite".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7028
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7029 *'updatetime'* *'ut'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7030 'updatetime' 'ut' number (default 4000)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7031 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7032 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7033 If this many milliseconds nothing is typed the swap file will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7034 written to disk (see |crash-recovery|). Also used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7035 |CursorHold| autocommand event.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7036
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7037 *'verbose'* *'vbs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7038 'verbose' 'vbs' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7039 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7040 {not in Vi, although some versions have a boolean
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7041 verbose option}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7042 When bigger than zero, Vim will give messages about what it is doing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7043 Currently, these messages are given:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7044 >= 1 When the viminfo file is read or written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7045 >= 2 When a file is ":source"'ed.
712
2e887dfa8917 updated for version 7.0214
vimboss
parents: 707
diff changeset
7046 >= 5 Every searched tags file and include file.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7047 >= 8 Files for which a group of autocommands is executed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7048 >= 9 Every executed autocommand.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7049 >= 12 Every executed function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7050 >= 13 When an exception is thrown, caught, finished, or discarded.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7051 >= 14 Anything pending in a ":finally" clause.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7052 >= 15 Every executed Ex command (truncated at 200 characters).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7053
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7054 This option can also be set with the "-V" argument. See |-V|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7055 This option is also set by the |:verbose| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7056
293
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7057 When the 'verbosefile' option is set then the verbose messages are not
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7058 displayed.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7059
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7060 *'verbosefile'* *'vfile'*
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7061 'verbosefile' 'vfile' string (default empty)
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7062 global
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7063 {not in Vi}
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7064 When not empty all messages are written in a file with this name.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7065 When the file exists messages are appended.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7066 Writing to the file ends when Vim exits or when 'verbosefile' is made
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7067 empty.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7068 Setting 'verbosefile' to a new value is like making it empty first.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7069 The difference with |:redir| is that verbose messages are not
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7070 displayed when 'verbosefile' is set.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7071
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7072 *'viewdir'* *'vdir'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7073 'viewdir' 'vdir' string (default for Amiga, MS-DOS, OS/2 and Win32:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7074 "$VIM/vimfiles/view",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7075 for Unix: "~/.vim/view",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7076 for Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles:view"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7077 for VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles/view"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7078 for RiscOS: "Choices:vimfiles/view")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7079 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7080 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7081 {not available when compiled without the +mksession
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7082 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7083 Name of the directory where to store files for |:mkview|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7084 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7085 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7086
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7087 *'viewoptions'* *'vop'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7088 'viewoptions' 'vop' string (default: "folds,options,cursor")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7089 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7090 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7091 {not available when compiled without the +mksession
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7092 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7093 Changes the effect of the |:mkview| command. It is a comma separated
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7094 list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring something:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7095 word save and restore ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7096 cursor cursor position in file and in window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7097 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7098 fold options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7099 options options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7100 global values for local options)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7101 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7102 slashes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7103 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7104 on Windows or DOS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7105
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7106 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing view files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7107 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7108 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7109
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7110 *'viminfo'* *'vi'* *E526* *E527* *E528*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7111 'viminfo' 'vi' string (Vi default: "", Vim default for MS-DOS,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7112 Windows and OS/2: '20,<50,s10,h,rA:,rB:,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7113 for Amiga: '20,<50,s10,h,rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7114 for others: '20,<50,s10,h)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7115 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7116 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7117 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7118 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7119 When non-empty, the viminfo file is read upon startup and written
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7120 when exiting Vim (see |viminfo-file|). The string should be a comma
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7121 separated list of parameters, each consisting of a single character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7122 identifying the particular parameter, followed by a number or string
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7123 which specifies the value of that parameter. If a particular
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7124 character is left out, then the default value is used for that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7125 parameter. The following is a list of the identifying characters and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7126 the effect of their value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7127 CHAR VALUE ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7128 ! When included, save and restore global variables that start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7129 with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7130 letter. Thus "KEEPTHIS and "K_L_M" are stored, but "KeepThis"
75
388f285bda1b updated for version 7.0031
vimboss
parents: 41
diff changeset
7131 and "_K_L_M" are not. Only String and Number types are
388f285bda1b updated for version 7.0031
vimboss
parents: 41
diff changeset
7132 stored.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7133 " Maximum number of lines saved for each register. Old name of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7134 the '<' item, with the disadvantage that you need to put a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7135 backslash before the ", otherwise it will be recognized as the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7136 start of a comment!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7137 % When included, save and restore the buffer list. If Vim is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7138 started with a file name argument, the buffer list is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7139 restored. If Vim is started without a file name argument, the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7140 buffer list is restored from the viminfo file. Buffers
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7141 without a file name and buffers for help files are not written
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7142 to the viminfo file.
23
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
7143 When followed by a number, the number specifies the maximum
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
7144 number of buffers that are stored. Without a number all
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
7145 buffers are stored.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7146 ' Maximum number of previously edited files for which the marks
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7147 are remembered. This parameter must always be included when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7148 'viminfo' is non-empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7149 Including this item also means that the |jumplist| and the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7150 |changelist| are stored in the viminfo file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7151 / Maximum number of items in the search pattern history to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7152 saved. If non-zero, then the previous search and substitute
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7153 patterns are also saved. When not included, the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7154 'history' is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7155 : Maximum number of items in the command-line history to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7156 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7157 < Maximum number of lines saved for each register. If zero then
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7158 registers are not saved. When not included, all lines are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7159 saved. '"' is the old name for this item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7160 Also see the 's' item below: limit specified in Kbyte.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7161 @ Maximum number of items in the input-line history to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7162 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7163 c When included, convert the text in the viminfo file from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7164 'encoding' used when writing the file to the current
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
7165 'encoding'. See |viminfo-encoding|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7166 f Whether file marks need to be stored. If zero, file marks ('0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7167 to '9, 'A to 'Z) are not stored. When not present or when
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7168 non-zero, they are all stored. '0 is used for the current
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7169 cursor position (when exiting or when doing ":wviminfo").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7170 h Disable the effect of 'hlsearch' when loading the viminfo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7171 file. When not included, it depends on whether ":nohlsearch"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7172 has been used since the last search command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7173 n Name of the viminfo file. The name must immediately follow
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7174 the 'n'. Must be the last one! If the "-i" argument was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7175 given when starting Vim, that file name overrides the one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7176 given here with 'viminfo'. Environment variables are expanded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7177 when opening the file, not when setting the option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7178 r Removable media. The argument is a string (up to the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7179 ','). This parameter can be given several times. Each
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7180 specifies the start of a path for which no marks will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7181 stored. This is to avoid removable media. For MS-DOS you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7182 could use "ra:,rb:", for Amiga "rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:". You can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7183 also use it for temp files, e.g., for Unix: "r/tmp". Case is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7184 ignored. Maximum length of each 'r' argument is 50
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7185 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7186 s Maximum size of an item in Kbyte. If zero then registers are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7187 not saved. Currently only applies to registers. The default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7188 "s10" will exclude registers with more than 10 Kbyte of text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7189 Also see the '<' item above: line count limit.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7190
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7191 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7192 :set viminfo='50,<1000,s100,:0,n~/vim/viminfo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7193 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7194 '50 Marks will be remembered for the last 50 files you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7195 edited.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7196 <1000 Contents of registers (up to 1000 lines each) will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7197 remembered.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7198 s100 Registers with more than 100 Kbyte text are skipped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7199 :0 Command-line history will not be saved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7200 n~/vim/viminfo The name of the file to use is "~/vim/viminfo".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7201 no / Since '/' is not specified, the default will be used,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7202 that is, save all of the search history, and also the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7203 previous search and substitute patterns.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7204 no % The buffer list will not be saved nor read back.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7205 no h 'hlsearch' highlighting will be restored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7206
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7207 When setting 'viminfo' from an empty value you can use |:rviminfo| to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7208 load the contents of the file, this is not done automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7209
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7210 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7211 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7212
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7213 *'virtualedit'* *'ve'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7214 'virtualedit' 've' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7215 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7216 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7217 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7218 |+virtualedit| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7219 A comma separated list of these words:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7220 block Allow virtual editing in Visual block mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7221 insert Allow virtual editing in Insert mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7222 all Allow virtual editing in all modes.
772
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
7223 onemore Allow the cursor to move just past the end of the line
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7224
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7225 Virtual editing means that the cursor can be positioned where there is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7226 no actual character. This can be halfway into a Tab or beyond the end
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7227 of the line. Useful for selecting a rectangle in Visual mode and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7228 editing a table.
772
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
7229 "onemore" is not the same, it will only allow moving the cursor just
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
7230 after the last character of the line. This makes some commands more
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
7231 consistent. Previously the cursor was always past the end of the line
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
7232 if the line was empty. But it is far from Vi compatible. It may also
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7233 break some plugins or Vim scripts. For example because |l| can move
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7234 the cursor after the last character. Use with care!
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7235 Using the |$| command will move to the last character in the line, not
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7236 past it. This may actually move the cursor to the left!
772
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
7237 It doesn't make sense to combine "all" with "onemore", but you will
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
7238 not get a warning for it.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7239
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7240 *'visualbell'* *'vb'* *'novisualbell'* *'novb'* *beep*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7241 'visualbell' 'vb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7242 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7243 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7244 Use visual bell instead of beeping. The terminal code to display the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7245 visual bell is given with 't_vb'. When no beep or flash is wanted,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7246 use ":set vb t_vb=".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7247 Note: When the GUI starts, 't_vb' is reset to its default value. You
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7248 might want to set it again in your |gvimrc|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7249 In the GUI, 't_vb' defaults to "<Esc>|f", which inverts the display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7250 for 20 msec. If you want to use a different time, use "<Esc>|40f",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7251 where 40 is the time in msec.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7252 Does not work on the Amiga, you always get a screen flash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7253 Also see 'errorbells'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7254
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7255 *'warn'* *'nowarn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7256 'warn' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7257 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7258 Give a warning message when a shell command is used while the buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7259 has been changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7260
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7261 *'weirdinvert'* *'wiv'* *'noweirdinvert'* *'nowiv'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7262 'weirdinvert' 'wiv' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7263 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7264 {not in Vi}
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
7265 This option has the same effect as the 't_xs' terminal option.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7266 It is provided for backwards compatibility with version 4.x.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7267 Setting 'weirdinvert' has the effect of making 't_xs' non-empty, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7268 vice versa. Has no effect when the GUI is running.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7269
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7270 *'whichwrap'* *'ww'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7271 'whichwrap' 'ww' string (Vim default: "b,s", Vi default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7272 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7273 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7274 Allow specified keys that move the cursor left/right to move to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7275 previous/next line when the cursor is on the first/last character in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7276 the line. Concatenate characters to allow this for these keys:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7277 char key mode ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7278 b <BS> Normal and Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7279 s <Space> Normal and Visual
712
2e887dfa8917 updated for version 7.0214
vimboss
parents: 707
diff changeset
7280 h "h" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
2e887dfa8917 updated for version 7.0214
vimboss
parents: 707
diff changeset
7281 l "l" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7282 < <Left> Normal and Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7283 > <Right> Normal and Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7284 ~ "~" Normal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7285 [ <Left> Insert and Replace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7286 ] <Right> Insert and Replace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7287 For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7288 :set ww=<,>,[,]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7289 < allows wrap only when cursor keys are used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7290 When the movement keys are used in combination with a delete or change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7291 operator, the <EOL> also counts for a character. This makes "3h"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7292 different from "3dh" when the cursor crosses the end of a line. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7293 is also true for "x" and "X", because they do the same as "dl" and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7294 "dh". If you use this, you may also want to use the mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7295 ":map <BS> X" to make backspace delete the character in front of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7296 cursor.
714
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
7297 When 'l' is included and it is used after an operator at the end of a
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
7298 line then it will not move to the next line. This makes "dl", "cl",
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
7299 "yl" etc. work normally.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7300 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7301 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7302
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7303 *'wildchar'* *'wc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7304 'wildchar' 'wc' number (Vim default: <Tab>, Vi default: CTRL-E)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7305 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7306 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7307 Character you have to type to start wildcard expansion in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7308 command-line, as specified with 'wildmode'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7309 The character is not recognized when used inside a macro. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7310 'wildcharm' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7311 Although 'wc' is a number option, you can set it to a special key: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7312 :set wc=<Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7313 < NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7314 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7315
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7316 *'wildcharm'* *'wcm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7317 'wildcharm' 'wcm' number (default: none (0))
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7318 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7319 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7320 'wildcharm' works exactly like 'wildchar', except that it is
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
7321 recognized when used inside a macro. You can find "spare" command-line
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
7322 keys suitable for this option by looking at |ex-edit-index|. Normally
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7323 you'll never actually type 'wildcharm', just use it in mappings that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7324 automatically invoke completion mode, e.g.: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7325 :set wcm=<C-Z>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7326 :cmap ss so $vim/sessions/*.vim<C-Z>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7327 < Then after typing :ss you can use CTRL-P & CTRL-N.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7328
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7329 *'wildignore'* *'wig'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7330 'wildignore' 'wig' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7331 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7332 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7333 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7334 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7335 A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7336 patterns is ignored when completing file or directory names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7337 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7338 Also see 'suffixes'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7339 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7340 :set wildignore=*.o,*.obj
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7341 < The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7342 a pattern from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7343 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7344
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7345 *'wildmenu'* *'wmnu'* *'nowildmenu'* *'nowmnu'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7346 'wildmenu' 'wmnu' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7347 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7348 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7349 {not available if compiled without the |+wildmenu|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7350 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7351 When 'wildmenu' is on, command-line completion operates in an enhanced
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7352 mode. On pressing 'wildchar' (usually <Tab>) to invoke completion,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7353 the possible matches are shown just above the command line, with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7354 first match highlighted (overwriting the status line, if there is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7355 one). Keys that show the previous/next match, such as <Tab> or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7356 CTRL-P/CTRL-N, cause the highlight to move to the appropriate match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7357 When 'wildmode' is used, "wildmenu" mode is used where "full" is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7358 specified. "longest" and "list" do not start "wildmenu" mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7359 If there are more matches than can fit in the line, a ">" is shown on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7360 the right and/or a "<" is shown on the left. The status line scrolls
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7361 as needed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7362 The "wildmenu" mode is abandoned when a key is hit that is not used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7363 for selecting a completion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7364 While the "wildmenu" is active the following keys have special
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7365 meanings:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7366
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7367 <Left> <Right> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7368 <Down> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7369 subdirectory or submenu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7370 <CR> - in menu completion, when the cursor is just after a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7371 dot: move into a submenu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7372 <Up> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7373 parent directory or parent menu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7374
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7375 This makes the menus accessible from the console |console-menus|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7376
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7377 If you prefer the <Left> and <Right> keys to move the cursor instead
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7378 of selecting a different match, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7379 :cnoremap <Left> <Space><BS><Left>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7380 :cnoremap <Right> <Space><BS><Right>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7381 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7382 The "WildMenu" highlighting is used for displaying the current match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7383 |hl-WildMenu|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7384
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7385 *'wildmode'* *'wim'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7386 'wildmode' 'wim' string (Vim default: "full")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7387 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7388 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7389 Completion mode that is used for the character specified with
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7390 'wildchar'. It is a comma separated list of up to four parts. Each
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7391 part specifies what to do for each consecutive use of 'wildchar. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7392 first part specifies the behavior for the first use of 'wildchar',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7393 The second part for the second use, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7394 These are the possible values for each part:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7395 "" Complete only the first match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7396 "full" Complete the next full match. After the last match,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7397 the original string is used and then the first match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7398 again.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7399 "longest" Complete till longest common string. If this doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7400 result in a longer string, use the next part.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7401 "longest:full" Like "longest", but also start 'wildmenu' if it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7402 enabled.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7403 "list" When more than one match, list all matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7404 "list:full" When more than one match, list all matches and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7405 complete first match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7406 "list:longest" When more than one match, list all matches and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7407 complete till longest common string.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7408 When there is only a single match, it is fully completed in all cases.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7409
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7410 Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7411 :set wildmode=full
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
7412 < Complete first full match, next match, etc. (the default) >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7413 :set wildmode=longest,full
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7414 < Complete longest common string, then each full match >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7415 :set wildmode=list:full
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7416 < List all matches and complete each full match >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7417 :set wildmode=list,full
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7418 < List all matches without completing, then each full match >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7419 :set wildmode=longest,list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7420 < Complete longest common string, then list alternatives.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7421
40
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7422 *'wildoptions'* *'wop'*
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7423 'wildoptions' 'wop' string (default "")
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7424 global
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7425 {not in Vi}
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7426 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7427 feature}
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7428 A list of words that change how command line completion is done.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7429 Currently only one word is allowed:
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7430 tagfile When using CTRL-D to list matching tags, the kind of
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7431 tag and the file of the tag is listed. Only one match
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7432 is displayed per line. Often used tag kinds are:
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7433 d #define
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7434 f function
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7435 Also see |cmdline-completion|.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7436
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7437 *'winaltkeys'* *'wak'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7438 'winaltkeys' 'wak' string (default "menu")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7439 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7440 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7441 {only used in Win32, Motif, GTK and Photon GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7442 Some GUI versions allow the access to menu entries by using the ALT
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7443 key in combination with a character that appears underlined in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7444 menu. This conflicts with the use of the ALT key for mappings and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7445 entering special characters. This option tells what to do:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7446 no Don't use ALT keys for menus. ALT key combinations can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7447 mapped, but there is no automatic handling. This can then be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7448 done with the |:simalt| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7449 yes ALT key handling is done by the windowing system. ALT key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7450 combinations cannot be mapped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7451 menu Using ALT in combination with a character that is a menu
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7452 shortcut key, will be handled by the windowing system. Other
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7453 keys can be mapped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7454 If the menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', the ALT
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7455 key is never used for the menu.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
7456 This option is not used for <F10>; on Win32 and with GTK <F10> will
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
7457 select the menu, unless it has been mapped.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7458
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7459 *'window'* *'wi'*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7460 'window' 'wi' number (default screen height - 1)
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7461 global
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7462 Window height. Do not confuse this with the height of the Vim window,
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7463 use 'lines' for that.
179
7fd70926e2e1 updated for version 7.0055
vimboss
parents: 170
diff changeset
7464 Used for |CTRL-F| and |CTRL-B| when there is only one window and the
7fd70926e2e1 updated for version 7.0055
vimboss
parents: 170
diff changeset
7465 value is smaller than 'lines' minus one. The screen will scroll
7fd70926e2e1 updated for version 7.0055
vimboss
parents: 170
diff changeset
7466 'window' minus two lines, with a minimum of one.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7467 When 'window' is equal to 'lines' minus one CTRL-F and CTRL-B scroll
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7468 in a much smarter way, taking care of wrapping lines.
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7469 When resizing the Vim window, the value is smaller than 1 or more than
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7470 or equal to 'lines' it will be set to 'lines' minus 1.
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7471 {Vi also uses the option to specify the number of displayed lines}
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7472
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7473 *'winheight'* *'wh'* *E591*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7474 'winheight' 'wh' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7475 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7476 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7477 {not available when compiled without the +windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7478 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7479 Minimal number of lines for the current window. This is not a hard
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7480 minimum, Vim will use fewer lines if there is not enough room. If the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7481 current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7482 height of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7483 always fill the screen (although this has the drawback that ":all"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7484 will create only two windows). Set it to a small number for normal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7485 editing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7486 Minimum value is 1.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7487 The height is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7488 height of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7489 'winheight' applies to the current window. Use 'winminheight' to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7490 the minimal height for other windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7491
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7492 *'winfixheight'* *'wfh'* *'nowinfixheight'* *'nowfh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7493 'winfixheight' 'wfh' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7494 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7495 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7496 {not available when compiled without the +windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7497 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7498 Keep the window height when windows are opened or closed and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7499 'equalalways' is set. Set by default for the |preview-window| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7500 |quickfix-window|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7501 The height may be changed anyway when running out of room.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7502
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7503 *'winfixwidth'* *'wfw'* *'nowinfixwidth'* *'nowfw'*
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7504 'winfixwidth' 'wfw' boolean (default off)
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7505 local to window
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7506 {not in Vi}
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7507 {not available when compiled without the +windows
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7508 feature}
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7509 Keep the window width when windows are opened or closed and
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7510 'equalalways' is set.
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7511 The width may be changed anyway when running out of room.
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7512
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7513 *'winminheight'* *'wmh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7514 'winminheight' 'wmh' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7515 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7516 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7517 {not available when compiled without the +windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7518 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7519 The minimal height of a window, when it's not the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7520 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7521 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero lines (i.e. just a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7522 status bar) if necessary. They will return to at least one line when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7523 they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere to go.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7524 Use 'winheight' to set the minimal height of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7525 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7526 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7527 windows. A value of 0 to 3 is reasonable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7528
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7529 *'winminwidth'* *'wmw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7530 'winminwidth' 'wmw' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7531 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7532 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7533 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7534 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7535 The minimal width of a window, when it's not the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7536 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7537 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero columns (i.e. just
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7538 a vertical separator) if necessary. They will return to at least one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7539 line when they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7540 to go.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7541 Use 'winwidth' to set the minimal width of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7542 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7543 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7544 windows. A value of 0 to 12 is reasonable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7545
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7546 *'winwidth'* *'wiw'* *E592*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7547 'winwidth' 'wiw' number (default 20)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7548 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7549 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7550 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7551 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7552 Minimal number of columns for the current window. This is not a hard
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7553 minimum, Vim will use fewer columns if there is not enough room. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7554 the current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7555 the width of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7556 always fill the screen. Set it to a small number for normal editing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7557 The width is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7558 width of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7559 'winwidth' applies to the current window. Use 'winminwidth' to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7560 the minimal width for other windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7561
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7562 *'wrap'* *'nowrap'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7563 'wrap' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7564 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7565 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7566 This option changes how text is displayed. It doesn't change the text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7567 in the buffer, see 'textwidth' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7568 When on, lines longer than the width of the window will wrap and
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7569 displaying continues on the next line. When off lines will not wrap
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7570 and only part of long lines will be displayed. When the cursor is
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7571 moved to a part that is not shown, the screen will scroll
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7572 horizontally.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7573 The line will be broken in the middle of a word if necessary. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7574 'linebreak' to get the break at a word boundary.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7575 To make scrolling horizontally a bit more useful, try this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7576 :set sidescroll=5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7577 :set listchars+=precedes:<,extends:>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7578 < See 'sidescroll', 'listchars' and |wrap-off|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7579
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7580 *'wrapmargin'* *'wm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7581 'wrapmargin' 'wm' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7582 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7583 Number of characters from the right window border where wrapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7584 starts. When typing text beyond this limit, an <EOL> will be inserted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7585 and inserting continues on the next line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7586 Options that add a margin, such as 'number' and 'foldcolumn', cause
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7587 the text width to be further reduced. This is Vi compatible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7588 When 'textwidth' is non-zero, this option is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7589 See also 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. {Vi: works differently
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7590 and less usefully}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7591
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7592 *'wrapscan'* *'ws'* *'nowrapscan'* *'nows'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7593 'wrapscan' 'ws' boolean (default on) *E384* *E385*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7594 global
500
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
7595 Searches wrap around the end of the file. Also applies to |]s| and
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
7596 |[s|, searching for spelling mistakes.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7597
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7598 *'write'* *'nowrite'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7599 'write' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7600 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7601 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7602 Allows writing files. When not set, writing a file is not allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7603 Can be used for a view-only mode, where modifications to the text are
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7604 still allowed. Can be reset with the |-m| or |-M| command line
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7605 argument. Filtering text is still possible, even though this requires
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7606 writing a temporary file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7607
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7608 *'writeany'* *'wa'* *'nowriteany'* *'nowa'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7609 'writeany' 'wa' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7610 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7611 Allows writing to any file with no need for "!" override.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7612
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7613 *'writebackup'* *'wb'* *'nowritebackup'* *'nowb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7614 'writebackup' 'wb' boolean (default on with |+writebackup| feature, off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7615 otherwise)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7616 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7617 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7618 Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7619 the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7620 also on. Reset this option if your file system is almost full. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7621 |backup-table| for another explanation.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7622 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7623 NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7624 set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7625
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7626 *'writedelay'* *'wd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7627 'writedelay' 'wd' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7628 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7629 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7630 The number of microseconds to wait for each character sent to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7631 screen. When non-zero, characters are sent to the terminal one by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7632 one. For MS-DOS pcterm this does not work. For debugging purposes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7633
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7634 vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:norl: